1 /* X86-64 specific support for ELF
2    Copyright (C) 2000-2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3    Contributed by Jan Hubicka <jh@suse.cz>.
4 
5    This file is part of BFD, the Binary File Descriptor library.
6 
7    This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8    it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9    the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
10    (at your option) any later version.
11 
12    This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13    but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14    MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
15    GNU General Public License for more details.
16 
17    You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18    along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
19    Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor, Boston,
20    MA 02110-1301, USA.  */
21 
22 #include "sysdep.h"
23 #include "bfd.h"
24 #include "bfdlink.h"
25 #include "libbfd.h"
26 #include "elf-bfd.h"
27 #include "elf-nacl.h"
28 #include "bfd_stdint.h"
29 #include "objalloc.h"
30 #include "hashtab.h"
31 #include "dwarf2.h"
32 #include "libiberty.h"
33 
34 #include "opcode/i386.h"
35 #include "elf/x86-64.h"
36 
37 #ifdef CORE_HEADER
38 #include <stdarg.h>
39 #include CORE_HEADER
40 #endif
41 
42 /* In case we're on a 32-bit machine, construct a 64-bit "-1" value.  */
43 #define MINUS_ONE (~ (bfd_vma) 0)
44 
45 /* Since both 32-bit and 64-bit x86-64 encode relocation type in the
46    identical manner, we use ELF32_R_TYPE instead of ELF64_R_TYPE to get
47    relocation type.  We also use ELF_ST_TYPE instead of ELF64_ST_TYPE
48    since they are the same.  */
49 
50 #define ABI_64_P(abfd) \
51   (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS64)
52 
53 /* The relocation "howto" table.  Order of fields:
54    type, rightshift, size, bitsize, pc_relative, bitpos, complain_on_overflow,
55    special_function, name, partial_inplace, src_mask, dst_mask, pcrel_offset.  */
56 static reloc_howto_type x86_64_elf_howto_table[] =
57 {
58   HOWTO(R_X86_64_NONE, 0, 3, 0, FALSE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
59 	bfd_elf_generic_reloc, "R_X86_64_NONE",	FALSE, 0x00000000, 0x00000000,
60 	FALSE),
61   HOWTO(R_X86_64_64, 0, 4, 64, FALSE, 0, complain_overflow_bitfield,
62 	bfd_elf_generic_reloc, "R_X86_64_64", FALSE, MINUS_ONE, MINUS_ONE,
63 	FALSE),
64   HOWTO(R_X86_64_PC32, 0, 2, 32, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_signed,
65 	bfd_elf_generic_reloc, "R_X86_64_PC32", FALSE, 0xffffffff, 0xffffffff,
66 	TRUE),
67   HOWTO(R_X86_64_GOT32, 0, 2, 32, FALSE, 0, complain_overflow_signed,
68 	bfd_elf_generic_reloc, "R_X86_64_GOT32", FALSE, 0xffffffff, 0xffffffff,
69 	FALSE),
70   HOWTO(R_X86_64_PLT32, 0, 2, 32, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_signed,
71 	bfd_elf_generic_reloc, "R_X86_64_PLT32", FALSE, 0xffffffff, 0xffffffff,
72 	TRUE),
73   HOWTO(R_X86_64_COPY, 0, 2, 32, FALSE, 0, complain_overflow_bitfield,
74 	bfd_elf_generic_reloc, "R_X86_64_COPY", FALSE, 0xffffffff, 0xffffffff,
75 	FALSE),
76   HOWTO(R_X86_64_GLOB_DAT, 0, 4, 64, FALSE, 0, complain_overflow_bitfield,
77 	bfd_elf_generic_reloc, "R_X86_64_GLOB_DAT", FALSE, MINUS_ONE,
78 	MINUS_ONE, FALSE),
79   HOWTO(R_X86_64_JUMP_SLOT, 0, 4, 64, FALSE, 0, complain_overflow_bitfield,
80 	bfd_elf_generic_reloc, "R_X86_64_JUMP_SLOT", FALSE, MINUS_ONE,
81 	MINUS_ONE, FALSE),
82   HOWTO(R_X86_64_RELATIVE, 0, 4, 64, FALSE, 0, complain_overflow_bitfield,
83 	bfd_elf_generic_reloc, "R_X86_64_RELATIVE", FALSE, MINUS_ONE,
84 	MINUS_ONE, FALSE),
85   HOWTO(R_X86_64_GOTPCREL, 0, 2, 32, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_signed,
86 	bfd_elf_generic_reloc, "R_X86_64_GOTPCREL", FALSE, 0xffffffff,
87 	0xffffffff, TRUE),
88   HOWTO(R_X86_64_32, 0, 2, 32, FALSE, 0, complain_overflow_unsigned,
89 	bfd_elf_generic_reloc, "R_X86_64_32", FALSE, 0xffffffff, 0xffffffff,
90 	FALSE),
91   HOWTO(R_X86_64_32S, 0, 2, 32, FALSE, 0, complain_overflow_signed,
92 	bfd_elf_generic_reloc, "R_X86_64_32S", FALSE, 0xffffffff, 0xffffffff,
93 	FALSE),
94   HOWTO(R_X86_64_16, 0, 1, 16, FALSE, 0, complain_overflow_bitfield,
95 	bfd_elf_generic_reloc, "R_X86_64_16", FALSE, 0xffff, 0xffff, FALSE),
96   HOWTO(R_X86_64_PC16,0, 1, 16, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_bitfield,
97 	bfd_elf_generic_reloc, "R_X86_64_PC16", FALSE, 0xffff, 0xffff, TRUE),
98   HOWTO(R_X86_64_8, 0, 0, 8, FALSE, 0, complain_overflow_bitfield,
99 	bfd_elf_generic_reloc, "R_X86_64_8", FALSE, 0xff, 0xff, FALSE),
100   HOWTO(R_X86_64_PC8, 0, 0, 8, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_signed,
101 	bfd_elf_generic_reloc, "R_X86_64_PC8", FALSE, 0xff, 0xff, TRUE),
102   HOWTO(R_X86_64_DTPMOD64, 0, 4, 64, FALSE, 0, complain_overflow_bitfield,
103 	bfd_elf_generic_reloc, "R_X86_64_DTPMOD64", FALSE, MINUS_ONE,
104 	MINUS_ONE, FALSE),
105   HOWTO(R_X86_64_DTPOFF64, 0, 4, 64, FALSE, 0, complain_overflow_bitfield,
106 	bfd_elf_generic_reloc, "R_X86_64_DTPOFF64", FALSE, MINUS_ONE,
107 	MINUS_ONE, FALSE),
108   HOWTO(R_X86_64_TPOFF64, 0, 4, 64, FALSE, 0, complain_overflow_bitfield,
109 	bfd_elf_generic_reloc, "R_X86_64_TPOFF64", FALSE, MINUS_ONE,
110 	MINUS_ONE, FALSE),
111   HOWTO(R_X86_64_TLSGD, 0, 2, 32, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_signed,
112 	bfd_elf_generic_reloc, "R_X86_64_TLSGD", FALSE, 0xffffffff,
113 	0xffffffff, TRUE),
114   HOWTO(R_X86_64_TLSLD, 0, 2, 32, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_signed,
115 	bfd_elf_generic_reloc, "R_X86_64_TLSLD", FALSE, 0xffffffff,
116 	0xffffffff, TRUE),
117   HOWTO(R_X86_64_DTPOFF32, 0, 2, 32, FALSE, 0, complain_overflow_signed,
118 	bfd_elf_generic_reloc, "R_X86_64_DTPOFF32", FALSE, 0xffffffff,
119 	0xffffffff, FALSE),
120   HOWTO(R_X86_64_GOTTPOFF, 0, 2, 32, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_signed,
121 	bfd_elf_generic_reloc, "R_X86_64_GOTTPOFF", FALSE, 0xffffffff,
122 	0xffffffff, TRUE),
123   HOWTO(R_X86_64_TPOFF32, 0, 2, 32, FALSE, 0, complain_overflow_signed,
124 	bfd_elf_generic_reloc, "R_X86_64_TPOFF32", FALSE, 0xffffffff,
125 	0xffffffff, FALSE),
126   HOWTO(R_X86_64_PC64, 0, 4, 64, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_bitfield,
127 	bfd_elf_generic_reloc, "R_X86_64_PC64", FALSE, MINUS_ONE, MINUS_ONE,
128 	TRUE),
129   HOWTO(R_X86_64_GOTOFF64, 0, 4, 64, FALSE, 0, complain_overflow_bitfield,
130 	bfd_elf_generic_reloc, "R_X86_64_GOTOFF64",
131 	FALSE, MINUS_ONE, MINUS_ONE, FALSE),
132   HOWTO(R_X86_64_GOTPC32, 0, 2, 32, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_signed,
133 	bfd_elf_generic_reloc, "R_X86_64_GOTPC32",
134 	FALSE, 0xffffffff, 0xffffffff, TRUE),
135   HOWTO(R_X86_64_GOT64, 0, 4, 64, FALSE, 0, complain_overflow_signed,
136 	bfd_elf_generic_reloc, "R_X86_64_GOT64", FALSE, MINUS_ONE, MINUS_ONE,
137 	FALSE),
138   HOWTO(R_X86_64_GOTPCREL64, 0, 4, 64, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_signed,
139 	bfd_elf_generic_reloc, "R_X86_64_GOTPCREL64", FALSE, MINUS_ONE,
140 	MINUS_ONE, TRUE),
141   HOWTO(R_X86_64_GOTPC64, 0, 4, 64, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_signed,
142 	bfd_elf_generic_reloc, "R_X86_64_GOTPC64",
143 	FALSE, MINUS_ONE, MINUS_ONE, TRUE),
144   HOWTO(R_X86_64_GOTPLT64, 0, 4, 64, FALSE, 0, complain_overflow_signed,
145 	bfd_elf_generic_reloc, "R_X86_64_GOTPLT64", FALSE, MINUS_ONE,
146 	MINUS_ONE, FALSE),
147   HOWTO(R_X86_64_PLTOFF64, 0, 4, 64, FALSE, 0, complain_overflow_signed,
148 	bfd_elf_generic_reloc, "R_X86_64_PLTOFF64", FALSE, MINUS_ONE,
149 	MINUS_ONE, FALSE),
150   HOWTO(R_X86_64_SIZE32, 0, 2, 32, FALSE, 0, complain_overflow_unsigned,
151 	bfd_elf_generic_reloc, "R_X86_64_SIZE32", FALSE, 0xffffffff, 0xffffffff,
152 	FALSE),
153   HOWTO(R_X86_64_SIZE64, 0, 4, 64, FALSE, 0, complain_overflow_unsigned,
154 	bfd_elf_generic_reloc, "R_X86_64_SIZE64", FALSE, MINUS_ONE, MINUS_ONE,
155 	FALSE),
156   HOWTO(R_X86_64_GOTPC32_TLSDESC, 0, 2, 32, TRUE, 0,
157 	complain_overflow_bitfield, bfd_elf_generic_reloc,
158 	"R_X86_64_GOTPC32_TLSDESC",
159 	FALSE, 0xffffffff, 0xffffffff, TRUE),
160   HOWTO(R_X86_64_TLSDESC_CALL, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, 0,
161 	complain_overflow_dont, bfd_elf_generic_reloc,
162 	"R_X86_64_TLSDESC_CALL",
163 	FALSE, 0, 0, FALSE),
164   HOWTO(R_X86_64_TLSDESC, 0, 4, 64, FALSE, 0,
165 	complain_overflow_bitfield, bfd_elf_generic_reloc,
166 	"R_X86_64_TLSDESC",
167 	FALSE, MINUS_ONE, MINUS_ONE, FALSE),
168   HOWTO(R_X86_64_IRELATIVE, 0, 4, 64, FALSE, 0, complain_overflow_bitfield,
169 	bfd_elf_generic_reloc, "R_X86_64_IRELATIVE", FALSE, MINUS_ONE,
170 	MINUS_ONE, FALSE),
171   HOWTO(R_X86_64_RELATIVE64, 0, 4, 64, FALSE, 0, complain_overflow_bitfield,
172 	bfd_elf_generic_reloc, "R_X86_64_RELATIVE64", FALSE, MINUS_ONE,
173 	MINUS_ONE, FALSE),
174   HOWTO(R_X86_64_PC32_BND, 0, 2, 32, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_signed,
175 	bfd_elf_generic_reloc, "R_X86_64_PC32_BND", FALSE, 0xffffffff, 0xffffffff,
176 	TRUE),
177   HOWTO(R_X86_64_PLT32_BND, 0, 2, 32, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_signed,
178 	bfd_elf_generic_reloc, "R_X86_64_PLT32_BND", FALSE, 0xffffffff, 0xffffffff,
179 	TRUE),
180   HOWTO(R_X86_64_GOTPCRELX, 0, 2, 32, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_signed,
181 	bfd_elf_generic_reloc, "R_X86_64_GOTPCRELX", FALSE, 0xffffffff,
182 	0xffffffff, TRUE),
183   HOWTO(R_X86_64_REX_GOTPCRELX, 0, 2, 32, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_signed,
184 	bfd_elf_generic_reloc, "R_X86_64_REX_GOTPCRELX", FALSE, 0xffffffff,
185 	0xffffffff, TRUE),
186 
187   /* We have a gap in the reloc numbers here.
188      R_X86_64_standard counts the number up to this point, and
189      R_X86_64_vt_offset is the value to subtract from a reloc type of
190      R_X86_64_GNU_VT* to form an index into this table.  */
191 #define R_X86_64_standard (R_X86_64_REX_GOTPCRELX + 1)
192 #define R_X86_64_vt_offset (R_X86_64_GNU_VTINHERIT - R_X86_64_standard)
193 
194 /* GNU extension to record C++ vtable hierarchy.  */
195   HOWTO (R_X86_64_GNU_VTINHERIT, 0, 4, 0, FALSE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
196 	 NULL, "R_X86_64_GNU_VTINHERIT", FALSE, 0, 0, FALSE),
197 
198 /* GNU extension to record C++ vtable member usage.  */
199   HOWTO (R_X86_64_GNU_VTENTRY, 0, 4, 0, FALSE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
200 	 _bfd_elf_rel_vtable_reloc_fn, "R_X86_64_GNU_VTENTRY", FALSE, 0, 0,
201 	 FALSE),
202 
203 /* Use complain_overflow_bitfield on R_X86_64_32 for x32.  */
204   HOWTO(R_X86_64_32, 0, 2, 32, FALSE, 0, complain_overflow_bitfield,
205 	bfd_elf_generic_reloc, "R_X86_64_32", FALSE, 0xffffffff, 0xffffffff,
206 	FALSE)
207 };
208 
209 #define IS_X86_64_PCREL_TYPE(TYPE)	\
210   (   ((TYPE) == R_X86_64_PC8)		\
211    || ((TYPE) == R_X86_64_PC16)		\
212    || ((TYPE) == R_X86_64_PC32)		\
213    || ((TYPE) == R_X86_64_PC32_BND)	\
214    || ((TYPE) == R_X86_64_PC64))
215 
216 /* Map BFD relocs to the x86_64 elf relocs.  */
217 struct elf_reloc_map
218 {
219   bfd_reloc_code_real_type bfd_reloc_val;
220   unsigned char elf_reloc_val;
221 };
222 
223 static const struct elf_reloc_map x86_64_reloc_map[] =
224 {
225   { BFD_RELOC_NONE,		R_X86_64_NONE, },
226   { BFD_RELOC_64,		R_X86_64_64,   },
227   { BFD_RELOC_32_PCREL,		R_X86_64_PC32, },
228   { BFD_RELOC_X86_64_GOT32,	R_X86_64_GOT32,},
229   { BFD_RELOC_X86_64_PLT32,	R_X86_64_PLT32,},
230   { BFD_RELOC_X86_64_COPY,	R_X86_64_COPY, },
231   { BFD_RELOC_X86_64_GLOB_DAT,	R_X86_64_GLOB_DAT, },
232   { BFD_RELOC_X86_64_JUMP_SLOT, R_X86_64_JUMP_SLOT, },
233   { BFD_RELOC_X86_64_RELATIVE,	R_X86_64_RELATIVE, },
234   { BFD_RELOC_X86_64_GOTPCREL,	R_X86_64_GOTPCREL, },
235   { BFD_RELOC_32,		R_X86_64_32, },
236   { BFD_RELOC_X86_64_32S,	R_X86_64_32S, },
237   { BFD_RELOC_16,		R_X86_64_16, },
238   { BFD_RELOC_16_PCREL,		R_X86_64_PC16, },
239   { BFD_RELOC_8,		R_X86_64_8, },
240   { BFD_RELOC_8_PCREL,		R_X86_64_PC8, },
241   { BFD_RELOC_X86_64_DTPMOD64,	R_X86_64_DTPMOD64, },
242   { BFD_RELOC_X86_64_DTPOFF64,	R_X86_64_DTPOFF64, },
243   { BFD_RELOC_X86_64_TPOFF64,	R_X86_64_TPOFF64, },
244   { BFD_RELOC_X86_64_TLSGD,	R_X86_64_TLSGD, },
245   { BFD_RELOC_X86_64_TLSLD,	R_X86_64_TLSLD, },
246   { BFD_RELOC_X86_64_DTPOFF32,	R_X86_64_DTPOFF32, },
247   { BFD_RELOC_X86_64_GOTTPOFF,	R_X86_64_GOTTPOFF, },
248   { BFD_RELOC_X86_64_TPOFF32,	R_X86_64_TPOFF32, },
249   { BFD_RELOC_64_PCREL,		R_X86_64_PC64, },
250   { BFD_RELOC_X86_64_GOTOFF64,	R_X86_64_GOTOFF64, },
251   { BFD_RELOC_X86_64_GOTPC32,	R_X86_64_GOTPC32, },
252   { BFD_RELOC_X86_64_GOT64,	R_X86_64_GOT64, },
253   { BFD_RELOC_X86_64_GOTPCREL64,R_X86_64_GOTPCREL64, },
254   { BFD_RELOC_X86_64_GOTPC64,	R_X86_64_GOTPC64, },
255   { BFD_RELOC_X86_64_GOTPLT64,	R_X86_64_GOTPLT64, },
256   { BFD_RELOC_X86_64_PLTOFF64,	R_X86_64_PLTOFF64, },
257   { BFD_RELOC_SIZE32,		R_X86_64_SIZE32, },
258   { BFD_RELOC_SIZE64,		R_X86_64_SIZE64, },
259   { BFD_RELOC_X86_64_GOTPC32_TLSDESC, R_X86_64_GOTPC32_TLSDESC, },
260   { BFD_RELOC_X86_64_TLSDESC_CALL, R_X86_64_TLSDESC_CALL, },
261   { BFD_RELOC_X86_64_TLSDESC,	R_X86_64_TLSDESC, },
262   { BFD_RELOC_X86_64_IRELATIVE,	R_X86_64_IRELATIVE, },
263   { BFD_RELOC_X86_64_PC32_BND,	R_X86_64_PC32_BND, },
264   { BFD_RELOC_X86_64_PLT32_BND,	R_X86_64_PLT32_BND, },
265   { BFD_RELOC_X86_64_GOTPCRELX, R_X86_64_GOTPCRELX, },
266   { BFD_RELOC_X86_64_REX_GOTPCRELX, R_X86_64_REX_GOTPCRELX, },
267   { BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_INHERIT,	R_X86_64_GNU_VTINHERIT, },
268   { BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_ENTRY,	R_X86_64_GNU_VTENTRY, },
269 };
270 
271 static reloc_howto_type *
272 elf_x86_64_rtype_to_howto (bfd *abfd, unsigned r_type)
273 {
274   unsigned i;
275 
276   if (r_type == (unsigned int) R_X86_64_32)
277     {
278       if (ABI_64_P (abfd))
279 	i = r_type;
280       else
281 	i = ARRAY_SIZE (x86_64_elf_howto_table) - 1;
282     }
283   else if (r_type < (unsigned int) R_X86_64_GNU_VTINHERIT
284 	   || r_type >= (unsigned int) R_X86_64_max)
285     {
286       if (r_type >= (unsigned int) R_X86_64_standard)
287 	{
288 	  (*_bfd_error_handler) (_("%B: invalid relocation type %d"),
289 				 abfd, (int) r_type);
290 	  r_type = R_X86_64_NONE;
291 	}
292       i = r_type;
293     }
294   else
295     i = r_type - (unsigned int) R_X86_64_vt_offset;
296   BFD_ASSERT (x86_64_elf_howto_table[i].type == r_type);
297   return &x86_64_elf_howto_table[i];
298 }
299 
300 /* Given a BFD reloc type, return a HOWTO structure.  */
301 static reloc_howto_type *
302 elf_x86_64_reloc_type_lookup (bfd *abfd,
303 			      bfd_reloc_code_real_type code)
304 {
305   unsigned int i;
306 
307   for (i = 0; i < sizeof (x86_64_reloc_map) / sizeof (struct elf_reloc_map);
308        i++)
309     {
310       if (x86_64_reloc_map[i].bfd_reloc_val == code)
311 	return elf_x86_64_rtype_to_howto (abfd,
312 					  x86_64_reloc_map[i].elf_reloc_val);
313     }
314   return NULL;
315 }
316 
317 static reloc_howto_type *
318 elf_x86_64_reloc_name_lookup (bfd *abfd,
319 			      const char *r_name)
320 {
321   unsigned int i;
322 
323   if (!ABI_64_P (abfd) && strcasecmp (r_name, "R_X86_64_32") == 0)
324     {
325       /* Get x32 R_X86_64_32.  */
326       reloc_howto_type *reloc
327 	= &x86_64_elf_howto_table[ARRAY_SIZE (x86_64_elf_howto_table) - 1];
328       BFD_ASSERT (reloc->type == (unsigned int) R_X86_64_32);
329       return reloc;
330     }
331 
332   for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (x86_64_elf_howto_table); i++)
333     if (x86_64_elf_howto_table[i].name != NULL
334 	&& strcasecmp (x86_64_elf_howto_table[i].name, r_name) == 0)
335       return &x86_64_elf_howto_table[i];
336 
337   return NULL;
338 }
339 
340 /* Given an x86_64 ELF reloc type, fill in an arelent structure.  */
341 
342 static void
343 elf_x86_64_info_to_howto (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, arelent *cache_ptr,
344 			  Elf_Internal_Rela *dst)
345 {
346   unsigned r_type;
347 
348   r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (dst->r_info);
349   cache_ptr->howto = elf_x86_64_rtype_to_howto (abfd, r_type);
350   BFD_ASSERT (r_type == cache_ptr->howto->type);
351 }
352 
353 /* Support for core dump NOTE sections.  */
354 static bfd_boolean
355 elf_x86_64_grok_prstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
356 {
357   int offset;
358   size_t size;
359 
360   switch (note->descsz)
361     {
362       default:
363 	return FALSE;
364 
365       case 296:		/* sizeof(istruct elf_prstatus) on Linux/x32 */
366 	/* pr_cursig */
367 	elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = bfd_get_16 (abfd, note->descdata + 12);
368 
369 	/* pr_pid */
370 	elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 24);
371 
372 	/* pr_reg */
373 	offset = 72;
374 	size = 216;
375 
376 	break;
377 
378       case 336:		/* sizeof(istruct elf_prstatus) on Linux/x86_64 */
379 	/* pr_cursig */
380 	elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal
381 	  = bfd_get_16 (abfd, note->descdata + 12);
382 
383 	/* pr_pid */
384 	elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid
385 	  = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 32);
386 
387 	/* pr_reg */
388 	offset = 112;
389 	size = 216;
390 
391 	break;
392     }
393 
394   /* Make a ".reg/999" section.  */
395   return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg",
396 					  size, note->descpos + offset);
397 }
398 
399 static bfd_boolean
400 elf_x86_64_grok_psinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
401 {
402   switch (note->descsz)
403     {
404       default:
405 	return FALSE;
406 
407       case 124:		/* sizeof(struct elf_prpsinfo) on Linux/x32 */
408 	elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
409 	  = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 12);
410 	elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
411 	  = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 28, 16);
412 	elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
413 	  = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 44, 80);
414 	break;
415 
416       case 136:		/* sizeof(struct elf_prpsinfo) on Linux/x86_64 */
417 	elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
418 	  = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 24);
419 	elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
420 	 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 40, 16);
421 	elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
422 	 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 56, 80);
423     }
424 
425   /* Note that for some reason, a spurious space is tacked
426      onto the end of the args in some (at least one anyway)
427      implementations, so strip it off if it exists.  */
428 
429   {
430     char *command = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command;
431     int n = strlen (command);
432 
433     if (0 < n && command[n - 1] == ' ')
434       command[n - 1] = '\0';
435   }
436 
437   return TRUE;
438 }
439 
440 #ifdef CORE_HEADER
441 static char *
442 elf_x86_64_write_core_note (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz,
443 			    int note_type, ...)
444 {
445   const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
446   va_list ap;
447   const char *fname, *psargs;
448   long pid;
449   int cursig;
450   const void *gregs;
451 
452   switch (note_type)
453     {
454     default:
455       return NULL;
456 
457     case NT_PRPSINFO:
458       va_start (ap, note_type);
459       fname = va_arg (ap, const char *);
460       psargs = va_arg (ap, const char *);
461       va_end (ap);
462 
463       if (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS32)
464 	{
465 	  prpsinfo32_t data;
466 	  memset (&data, 0, sizeof (data));
467 	  strncpy (data.pr_fname, fname, sizeof (data.pr_fname));
468 	  strncpy (data.pr_psargs, psargs, sizeof (data.pr_psargs));
469 	  return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, "CORE", note_type,
470 				     &data, sizeof (data));
471 	}
472       else
473 	{
474 	  prpsinfo64_t data;
475 	  memset (&data, 0, sizeof (data));
476 	  strncpy (data.pr_fname, fname, sizeof (data.pr_fname));
477 	  strncpy (data.pr_psargs, psargs, sizeof (data.pr_psargs));
478 	  return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, "CORE", note_type,
479 				     &data, sizeof (data));
480 	}
481       /* NOTREACHED */
482 
483     case NT_PRSTATUS:
484       va_start (ap, note_type);
485       pid = va_arg (ap, long);
486       cursig = va_arg (ap, int);
487       gregs = va_arg (ap, const void *);
488       va_end (ap);
489 
490       if (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS32)
491 	{
492 	  if (bed->elf_machine_code == EM_X86_64)
493 	    {
494 	      prstatusx32_t prstat;
495 	      memset (&prstat, 0, sizeof (prstat));
496 	      prstat.pr_pid = pid;
497 	      prstat.pr_cursig = cursig;
498 	      memcpy (&prstat.pr_reg, gregs, sizeof (prstat.pr_reg));
499 	      return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, "CORE", note_type,
500 					 &prstat, sizeof (prstat));
501 	    }
502 	  else
503 	    {
504 	      prstatus32_t prstat;
505 	      memset (&prstat, 0, sizeof (prstat));
506 	      prstat.pr_pid = pid;
507 	      prstat.pr_cursig = cursig;
508 	      memcpy (&prstat.pr_reg, gregs, sizeof (prstat.pr_reg));
509 	      return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, "CORE", note_type,
510 					 &prstat, sizeof (prstat));
511 	    }
512 	}
513       else
514 	{
515 	  prstatus64_t prstat;
516 	  memset (&prstat, 0, sizeof (prstat));
517 	  prstat.pr_pid = pid;
518 	  prstat.pr_cursig = cursig;
519 	  memcpy (&prstat.pr_reg, gregs, sizeof (prstat.pr_reg));
520 	  return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, "CORE", note_type,
521 				     &prstat, sizeof (prstat));
522 	}
523     }
524   /* NOTREACHED */
525 }
526 #endif
527 
528 /* Functions for the x86-64 ELF linker.	 */
529 
530 /* The name of the dynamic interpreter.	 This is put in the .interp
531    section.  */
532 
533 #define ELF64_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER "/libexec/ld-elf.so.2"
534 #define ELF32_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER "/lib/ldx32.so.1"
535 
536 /* If ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS is non-zero, the linker will try to avoid
537    copying dynamic variables from a shared lib into an app's dynbss
538    section, and instead use a dynamic relocation to point into the
539    shared lib.  */
540 #define ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS 1
541 
542 /* The size in bytes of an entry in the global offset table.  */
543 
544 #define GOT_ENTRY_SIZE 8
545 
546 /* The size in bytes of an entry in the procedure linkage table.  */
547 
548 #define PLT_ENTRY_SIZE 16
549 
550 /* The first entry in a procedure linkage table looks like this.  See the
551    SVR4 ABI i386 supplement and the x86-64 ABI to see how this works.  */
552 
553 static const bfd_byte elf_x86_64_plt0_entry[PLT_ENTRY_SIZE] =
554 {
555   0xff, 0x35, 8, 0, 0, 0,	/* pushq GOT+8(%rip)  */
556   0xff, 0x25, 16, 0, 0, 0,	/* jmpq *GOT+16(%rip) */
557   0x0f, 0x1f, 0x40, 0x00	/* nopl 0(%rax)       */
558 };
559 
560 /* Subsequent entries in a procedure linkage table look like this.  */
561 
562 static const bfd_byte elf_x86_64_plt_entry[PLT_ENTRY_SIZE] =
563 {
564   0xff, 0x25,	/* jmpq *name@GOTPC(%rip) */
565   0, 0, 0, 0,	/* replaced with offset to this symbol in .got.	 */
566   0x68,		/* pushq immediate */
567   0, 0, 0, 0,	/* replaced with index into relocation table.  */
568   0xe9,		/* jmp relative */
569   0, 0, 0, 0	/* replaced with offset to start of .plt0.  */
570 };
571 
572 /* The first entry in a procedure linkage table with BND relocations
573    like this.  */
574 
575 static const bfd_byte elf_x86_64_bnd_plt0_entry[PLT_ENTRY_SIZE] =
576 {
577   0xff, 0x35, 8, 0, 0, 0,         /* pushq GOT+8(%rip)        */
578   0xf2, 0xff, 0x25, 16, 0, 0, 0,  /* bnd jmpq *GOT+16(%rip)   */
579   0x0f, 0x1f, 0                   /* nopl (%rax)              */
580 };
581 
582 /* Subsequent entries for legacy branches in a procedure linkage table
583    with BND relocations look like this.  */
584 
585 static const bfd_byte elf_x86_64_legacy_plt_entry[PLT_ENTRY_SIZE] =
586 {
587   0x68, 0, 0, 0, 0,             /* pushq immediate            */
588   0xe9, 0, 0, 0, 0,             /* jmpq relative              */
589   0x66, 0x0f, 0x1f, 0x44, 0, 0  /* nopw (%rax,%rax,1)         */
590 };
591 
592 /* Subsequent entries for branches with BND prefx in a procedure linkage
593    table with BND relocations look like this.  */
594 
595 static const bfd_byte elf_x86_64_bnd_plt_entry[PLT_ENTRY_SIZE] =
596 {
597   0x68, 0, 0, 0, 0,             /* pushq immediate            */
598   0xf2, 0xe9, 0, 0, 0, 0,       /* bnd jmpq relative          */
599   0x0f, 0x1f, 0x44, 0, 0        /* nopl 0(%rax,%rax,1)        */
600 };
601 
602 /* Entries for legacy branches in the second procedure linkage table
603    look like this.  */
604 
605 static const bfd_byte elf_x86_64_legacy_plt2_entry[8] =
606 {
607   0xff, 0x25,                    /* jmpq *name@GOTPC(%rip)      */
608   0, 0, 0, 0,  /* replaced with offset to this symbol in .got.  */
609   0x66, 0x90                     /* xchg %ax,%ax                */
610 };
611 
612 /* Entries for branches with BND prefix in the second procedure linkage
613    table look like this.  */
614 
615 static const bfd_byte elf_x86_64_bnd_plt2_entry[8] =
616 {
617   0xf2, 0xff, 0x25,              /* bnd jmpq *name@GOTPC(%rip)  */
618   0, 0, 0, 0,  /* replaced with offset to this symbol in .got.  */
619   0x90                           /* nop                         */
620 };
621 
622 /* .eh_frame covering the .plt section.  */
623 
624 static const bfd_byte elf_x86_64_eh_frame_plt[] =
625 {
626 #define PLT_CIE_LENGTH		20
627 #define PLT_FDE_LENGTH		36
628 #define PLT_FDE_START_OFFSET	4 + PLT_CIE_LENGTH + 8
629 #define PLT_FDE_LEN_OFFSET	4 + PLT_CIE_LENGTH + 12
630   PLT_CIE_LENGTH, 0, 0, 0,	/* CIE length */
631   0, 0, 0, 0,			/* CIE ID */
632   1,				/* CIE version */
633   'z', 'R', 0,			/* Augmentation string */
634   1,				/* Code alignment factor */
635   0x78,				/* Data alignment factor */
636   16,				/* Return address column */
637   1,				/* Augmentation size */
638   DW_EH_PE_pcrel | DW_EH_PE_sdata4, /* FDE encoding */
639   DW_CFA_def_cfa, 7, 8,		/* DW_CFA_def_cfa: r7 (rsp) ofs 8 */
640   DW_CFA_offset + 16, 1,	/* DW_CFA_offset: r16 (rip) at cfa-8 */
641   DW_CFA_nop, DW_CFA_nop,
642 
643   PLT_FDE_LENGTH, 0, 0, 0,	/* FDE length */
644   PLT_CIE_LENGTH + 8, 0, 0, 0,	/* CIE pointer */
645   0, 0, 0, 0,			/* R_X86_64_PC32 .plt goes here */
646   0, 0, 0, 0,			/* .plt size goes here */
647   0,				/* Augmentation size */
648   DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset, 16,	/* DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset: 16 */
649   DW_CFA_advance_loc + 6,	/* DW_CFA_advance_loc: 6 to __PLT__+6 */
650   DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset, 24,	/* DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset: 24 */
651   DW_CFA_advance_loc + 10,	/* DW_CFA_advance_loc: 10 to __PLT__+16 */
652   DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression,	/* DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression */
653   11,				/* Block length */
654   DW_OP_breg7, 8,		/* DW_OP_breg7 (rsp): 8 */
655   DW_OP_breg16, 0,		/* DW_OP_breg16 (rip): 0 */
656   DW_OP_lit15, DW_OP_and, DW_OP_lit11, DW_OP_ge,
657   DW_OP_lit3, DW_OP_shl, DW_OP_plus,
658   DW_CFA_nop, DW_CFA_nop, DW_CFA_nop, DW_CFA_nop
659 };
660 
661 /* Architecture-specific backend data for x86-64.  */
662 
663 struct elf_x86_64_backend_data
664 {
665   /* Templates for the initial PLT entry and for subsequent entries.  */
666   const bfd_byte *plt0_entry;
667   const bfd_byte *plt_entry;
668   unsigned int plt_entry_size;          /* Size of each PLT entry.  */
669 
670   /* Offsets into plt0_entry that are to be replaced with GOT[1] and GOT[2].  */
671   unsigned int plt0_got1_offset;
672   unsigned int plt0_got2_offset;
673 
674   /* Offset of the end of the PC-relative instruction containing
675      plt0_got2_offset.  */
676   unsigned int plt0_got2_insn_end;
677 
678   /* Offsets into plt_entry that are to be replaced with...  */
679   unsigned int plt_got_offset;    /* ... address of this symbol in .got. */
680   unsigned int plt_reloc_offset;  /* ... offset into relocation table. */
681   unsigned int plt_plt_offset;    /* ... offset to start of .plt. */
682 
683   /* Length of the PC-relative instruction containing plt_got_offset.  */
684   unsigned int plt_got_insn_size;
685 
686   /* Offset of the end of the PC-relative jump to plt0_entry.  */
687   unsigned int plt_plt_insn_end;
688 
689   /* Offset into plt_entry where the initial value of the GOT entry points.  */
690   unsigned int plt_lazy_offset;
691 
692   /* .eh_frame covering the .plt section.  */
693   const bfd_byte *eh_frame_plt;
694   unsigned int eh_frame_plt_size;
695 };
696 
697 #define get_elf_x86_64_arch_data(bed) \
698   ((const struct elf_x86_64_backend_data *) (bed)->arch_data)
699 
700 #define get_elf_x86_64_backend_data(abfd) \
701   get_elf_x86_64_arch_data (get_elf_backend_data (abfd))
702 
703 #define GET_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE(abfd) \
704   get_elf_x86_64_backend_data (abfd)->plt_entry_size
705 
706 /* These are the standard parameters.  */
707 static const struct elf_x86_64_backend_data elf_x86_64_arch_bed =
708   {
709     elf_x86_64_plt0_entry,              /* plt0_entry */
710     elf_x86_64_plt_entry,               /* plt_entry */
711     sizeof (elf_x86_64_plt_entry),      /* plt_entry_size */
712     2,                                  /* plt0_got1_offset */
713     8,                                  /* plt0_got2_offset */
714     12,                                 /* plt0_got2_insn_end */
715     2,                                  /* plt_got_offset */
716     7,                                  /* plt_reloc_offset */
717     12,                                 /* plt_plt_offset */
718     6,                                  /* plt_got_insn_size */
719     PLT_ENTRY_SIZE,                     /* plt_plt_insn_end */
720     6,                                  /* plt_lazy_offset */
721     elf_x86_64_eh_frame_plt,            /* eh_frame_plt */
722     sizeof (elf_x86_64_eh_frame_plt),   /* eh_frame_plt_size */
723   };
724 
725 static const struct elf_x86_64_backend_data elf_x86_64_bnd_arch_bed =
726   {
727     elf_x86_64_bnd_plt0_entry,          /* plt0_entry */
728     elf_x86_64_bnd_plt_entry,           /* plt_entry */
729     sizeof (elf_x86_64_bnd_plt_entry),  /* plt_entry_size */
730     2,                                  /* plt0_got1_offset */
731     1+8,                                /* plt0_got2_offset */
732     1+12,                               /* plt0_got2_insn_end */
733     1+2,                                /* plt_got_offset */
734     1,                                  /* plt_reloc_offset */
735     7,                                  /* plt_plt_offset */
736     1+6,                                /* plt_got_insn_size */
737     11,                                 /* plt_plt_insn_end */
738     0,                                  /* plt_lazy_offset */
739     elf_x86_64_eh_frame_plt,            /* eh_frame_plt */
740     sizeof (elf_x86_64_eh_frame_plt),   /* eh_frame_plt_size */
741   };
742 
743 #define	elf_backend_arch_data	&elf_x86_64_arch_bed
744 
745 /* Is a undefined weak symbol which is resolved to 0.  Reference to an
746    undefined weak symbol is resolved to 0 when building executable if
747    it isn't dynamic and
748    1. Has non-GOT/non-PLT relocations in text section.  Or
749    2. Has no GOT/PLT relocation.
750  */
751 #define UNDEFINED_WEAK_RESOLVED_TO_ZERO(INFO, GOT_RELOC, EH)	\
752   ((EH)->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak		\
753    && bfd_link_executable (INFO)				\
754    && (elf_x86_64_hash_table (INFO)->interp == NULL	 	\
755        || !(GOT_RELOC)						\
756        || (EH)->has_non_got_reloc				\
757        || !(INFO)->dynamic_undefined_weak))
758 
759 /* x86-64 ELF linker hash entry.  */
760 
761 struct elf_x86_64_link_hash_entry
762 {
763   struct elf_link_hash_entry elf;
764 
765   /* Track dynamic relocs copied for this symbol.  */
766   struct elf_dyn_relocs *dyn_relocs;
767 
768 #define GOT_UNKNOWN	0
769 #define GOT_NORMAL	1
770 #define GOT_TLS_GD	2
771 #define GOT_TLS_IE	3
772 #define GOT_TLS_GDESC	4
773 #define GOT_TLS_GD_BOTH_P(type) \
774   ((type) == (GOT_TLS_GD | GOT_TLS_GDESC))
775 #define GOT_TLS_GD_P(type) \
776   ((type) == GOT_TLS_GD || GOT_TLS_GD_BOTH_P (type))
777 #define GOT_TLS_GDESC_P(type) \
778   ((type) == GOT_TLS_GDESC || GOT_TLS_GD_BOTH_P (type))
779 #define GOT_TLS_GD_ANY_P(type) \
780   (GOT_TLS_GD_P (type) || GOT_TLS_GDESC_P (type))
781   unsigned char tls_type;
782 
783   /* TRUE if a weak symbol with a real definition needs a copy reloc.
784      When there is a weak symbol with a real definition, the processor
785      independent code will have arranged for us to see the real
786      definition first.  We need to copy the needs_copy bit from the
787      real definition and check it when allowing copy reloc in PIE.  */
788   unsigned int needs_copy : 1;
789 
790   /* TRUE if symbol has at least one BND relocation.  */
791   unsigned int has_bnd_reloc : 1;
792 
793   /* TRUE if symbol has GOT or PLT relocations.  */
794   unsigned int has_got_reloc : 1;
795 
796   /* TRUE if symbol has non-GOT/non-PLT relocations in text sections.  */
797   unsigned int has_non_got_reloc : 1;
798 
799   /* 0: symbol isn't __tls_get_addr.
800      1: symbol is __tls_get_addr.
801      2: symbol is unknown.  */
802   unsigned int tls_get_addr : 2;
803 
804   /* Reference count of C/C++ function pointer relocations in read-write
805      section which can be resolved at run-time.  */
806   bfd_signed_vma func_pointer_refcount;
807 
808   /* Information about the GOT PLT entry. Filled when there are both
809      GOT and PLT relocations against the same function.  */
810   union gotplt_union plt_got;
811 
812   /* Information about the second PLT entry. Filled when has_bnd_reloc is
813      set.  */
814   union gotplt_union plt_bnd;
815 
816   /* Offset of the GOTPLT entry reserved for the TLS descriptor,
817      starting at the end of the jump table.  */
818   bfd_vma tlsdesc_got;
819 };
820 
821 #define elf_x86_64_hash_entry(ent) \
822   ((struct elf_x86_64_link_hash_entry *)(ent))
823 
824 struct elf_x86_64_obj_tdata
825 {
826   struct elf_obj_tdata root;
827 
828   /* tls_type for each local got entry.  */
829   char *local_got_tls_type;
830 
831   /* GOTPLT entries for TLS descriptors.  */
832   bfd_vma *local_tlsdesc_gotent;
833 };
834 
835 #define elf_x86_64_tdata(abfd) \
836   ((struct elf_x86_64_obj_tdata *) (abfd)->tdata.any)
837 
838 #define elf_x86_64_local_got_tls_type(abfd) \
839   (elf_x86_64_tdata (abfd)->local_got_tls_type)
840 
841 #define elf_x86_64_local_tlsdesc_gotent(abfd) \
842   (elf_x86_64_tdata (abfd)->local_tlsdesc_gotent)
843 
844 #define is_x86_64_elf(bfd)				\
845   (bfd_get_flavour (bfd) == bfd_target_elf_flavour	\
846    && elf_tdata (bfd) != NULL				\
847    && elf_object_id (bfd) == X86_64_ELF_DATA)
848 
849 static bfd_boolean
850 elf_x86_64_mkobject (bfd *abfd)
851 {
852   return bfd_elf_allocate_object (abfd, sizeof (struct elf_x86_64_obj_tdata),
853 				  X86_64_ELF_DATA);
854 }
855 
856 /* x86-64 ELF linker hash table.  */
857 
858 struct elf_x86_64_link_hash_table
859 {
860   struct elf_link_hash_table elf;
861 
862   /* Short-cuts to get to dynamic linker sections.  */
863   asection *interp;
864   asection *sdynbss;
865   asection *srelbss;
866   asection *plt_eh_frame;
867   asection *plt_bnd;
868   asection *plt_got;
869 
870   union
871   {
872     bfd_signed_vma refcount;
873     bfd_vma offset;
874   } tls_ld_got;
875 
876   /* The amount of space used by the jump slots in the GOT.  */
877   bfd_vma sgotplt_jump_table_size;
878 
879   /* Small local sym cache.  */
880   struct sym_cache sym_cache;
881 
882   bfd_vma (*r_info) (bfd_vma, bfd_vma);
883   bfd_vma (*r_sym) (bfd_vma);
884   unsigned int pointer_r_type;
885   const char *dynamic_interpreter;
886   int dynamic_interpreter_size;
887 
888   /* _TLS_MODULE_BASE_ symbol.  */
889   struct bfd_link_hash_entry *tls_module_base;
890 
891   /* Used by local STT_GNU_IFUNC symbols.  */
892   htab_t loc_hash_table;
893   void * loc_hash_memory;
894 
895   /* The offset into splt of the PLT entry for the TLS descriptor
896      resolver.  Special values are 0, if not necessary (or not found
897      to be necessary yet), and -1 if needed but not determined
898      yet.  */
899   bfd_vma tlsdesc_plt;
900   /* The offset into sgot of the GOT entry used by the PLT entry
901      above.  */
902   bfd_vma tlsdesc_got;
903 
904   /* The index of the next R_X86_64_JUMP_SLOT entry in .rela.plt.  */
905   bfd_vma next_jump_slot_index;
906   /* The index of the next R_X86_64_IRELATIVE entry in .rela.plt.  */
907   bfd_vma next_irelative_index;
908 
909   /* TRUE if there are dynamic relocs against IFUNC symbols that apply
910      to read-only sections.  */
911   bfd_boolean readonly_dynrelocs_against_ifunc;
912 };
913 
914 /* Get the x86-64 ELF linker hash table from a link_info structure.  */
915 
916 #define elf_x86_64_hash_table(p) \
917   (elf_hash_table_id ((struct elf_link_hash_table *) ((p)->hash)) \
918   == X86_64_ELF_DATA ? ((struct elf_x86_64_link_hash_table *) ((p)->hash)) : NULL)
919 
920 #define elf_x86_64_compute_jump_table_size(htab) \
921   ((htab)->elf.srelplt->reloc_count * GOT_ENTRY_SIZE)
922 
923 /* Create an entry in an x86-64 ELF linker hash table.	*/
924 
925 static struct bfd_hash_entry *
926 elf_x86_64_link_hash_newfunc (struct bfd_hash_entry *entry,
927 			      struct bfd_hash_table *table,
928 			      const char *string)
929 {
930   /* Allocate the structure if it has not already been allocated by a
931      subclass.  */
932   if (entry == NULL)
933     {
934       entry = (struct bfd_hash_entry *)
935 	  bfd_hash_allocate (table,
936 			     sizeof (struct elf_x86_64_link_hash_entry));
937       if (entry == NULL)
938 	return entry;
939     }
940 
941   /* Call the allocation method of the superclass.  */
942   entry = _bfd_elf_link_hash_newfunc (entry, table, string);
943   if (entry != NULL)
944     {
945       struct elf_x86_64_link_hash_entry *eh;
946 
947       eh = (struct elf_x86_64_link_hash_entry *) entry;
948       eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
949       eh->tls_type = GOT_UNKNOWN;
950       eh->needs_copy = 0;
951       eh->has_bnd_reloc = 0;
952       eh->has_got_reloc = 0;
953       eh->has_non_got_reloc = 0;
954       eh->tls_get_addr = 2;
955       eh->func_pointer_refcount = 0;
956       eh->plt_bnd.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
957       eh->plt_got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
958       eh->tlsdesc_got = (bfd_vma) -1;
959     }
960 
961   return entry;
962 }
963 
964 /* Compute a hash of a local hash entry.  We use elf_link_hash_entry
965   for local symbol so that we can handle local STT_GNU_IFUNC symbols
966   as global symbol.  We reuse indx and dynstr_index for local symbol
967   hash since they aren't used by global symbols in this backend.  */
968 
969 static hashval_t
970 elf_x86_64_local_htab_hash (const void *ptr)
971 {
972   struct elf_link_hash_entry *h
973     = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) ptr;
974   return ELF_LOCAL_SYMBOL_HASH (h->indx, h->dynstr_index);
975 }
976 
977 /* Compare local hash entries.  */
978 
979 static int
980 elf_x86_64_local_htab_eq (const void *ptr1, const void *ptr2)
981 {
982   struct elf_link_hash_entry *h1
983      = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) ptr1;
984   struct elf_link_hash_entry *h2
985     = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) ptr2;
986 
987   return h1->indx == h2->indx && h1->dynstr_index == h2->dynstr_index;
988 }
989 
990 /* Find and/or create a hash entry for local symbol.  */
991 
992 static struct elf_link_hash_entry *
993 elf_x86_64_get_local_sym_hash (struct elf_x86_64_link_hash_table *htab,
994 			       bfd *abfd, const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
995 			       bfd_boolean create)
996 {
997   struct elf_x86_64_link_hash_entry e, *ret;
998   asection *sec = abfd->sections;
999   hashval_t h = ELF_LOCAL_SYMBOL_HASH (sec->id,
1000 				       htab->r_sym (rel->r_info));
1001   void **slot;
1002 
1003   e.elf.indx = sec->id;
1004   e.elf.dynstr_index = htab->r_sym (rel->r_info);
1005   slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (htab->loc_hash_table, &e, h,
1006 				   create ? INSERT : NO_INSERT);
1007 
1008   if (!slot)
1009     return NULL;
1010 
1011   if (*slot)
1012     {
1013       ret = (struct elf_x86_64_link_hash_entry *) *slot;
1014       return &ret->elf;
1015     }
1016 
1017   ret = (struct elf_x86_64_link_hash_entry *)
1018 	objalloc_alloc ((struct objalloc *) htab->loc_hash_memory,
1019 			sizeof (struct elf_x86_64_link_hash_entry));
1020   if (ret)
1021     {
1022       memset (ret, 0, sizeof (*ret));
1023       ret->elf.indx = sec->id;
1024       ret->elf.dynstr_index = htab->r_sym (rel->r_info);
1025       ret->elf.dynindx = -1;
1026       ret->func_pointer_refcount = 0;
1027       ret->plt_got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
1028       *slot = ret;
1029     }
1030   return &ret->elf;
1031 }
1032 
1033 /* Destroy an X86-64 ELF linker hash table.  */
1034 
1035 static void
1036 elf_x86_64_link_hash_table_free (bfd *obfd)
1037 {
1038   struct elf_x86_64_link_hash_table *htab
1039     = (struct elf_x86_64_link_hash_table *) obfd->link.hash;
1040 
1041   if (htab->loc_hash_table)
1042     htab_delete (htab->loc_hash_table);
1043   if (htab->loc_hash_memory)
1044     objalloc_free ((struct objalloc *) htab->loc_hash_memory);
1045   _bfd_elf_link_hash_table_free (obfd);
1046 }
1047 
1048 /* Create an X86-64 ELF linker hash table.  */
1049 
1050 static struct bfd_link_hash_table *
1051 elf_x86_64_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
1052 {
1053   struct elf_x86_64_link_hash_table *ret;
1054   bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (struct elf_x86_64_link_hash_table);
1055 
1056   ret = (struct elf_x86_64_link_hash_table *) bfd_zmalloc (amt);
1057   if (ret == NULL)
1058     return NULL;
1059 
1060   if (!_bfd_elf_link_hash_table_init (&ret->elf, abfd,
1061 				      elf_x86_64_link_hash_newfunc,
1062 				      sizeof (struct elf_x86_64_link_hash_entry),
1063 				      X86_64_ELF_DATA))
1064     {
1065       free (ret);
1066       return NULL;
1067     }
1068 
1069   if (ABI_64_P (abfd))
1070     {
1071       ret->r_info = elf64_r_info;
1072       ret->r_sym = elf64_r_sym;
1073       ret->pointer_r_type = R_X86_64_64;
1074       ret->dynamic_interpreter = ELF64_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER;
1075       ret->dynamic_interpreter_size = sizeof ELF64_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER;
1076     }
1077   else
1078     {
1079       ret->r_info = elf32_r_info;
1080       ret->r_sym = elf32_r_sym;
1081       ret->pointer_r_type = R_X86_64_32;
1082       ret->dynamic_interpreter = ELF32_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER;
1083       ret->dynamic_interpreter_size = sizeof ELF32_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER;
1084     }
1085 
1086   ret->loc_hash_table = htab_try_create (1024,
1087 					 elf_x86_64_local_htab_hash,
1088 					 elf_x86_64_local_htab_eq,
1089 					 NULL);
1090   ret->loc_hash_memory = objalloc_create ();
1091   if (!ret->loc_hash_table || !ret->loc_hash_memory)
1092     {
1093       elf_x86_64_link_hash_table_free (abfd);
1094       return NULL;
1095     }
1096   ret->elf.root.hash_table_free = elf_x86_64_link_hash_table_free;
1097 
1098   return &ret->elf.root;
1099 }
1100 
1101 /* Create .plt, .rela.plt, .got, .got.plt, .rela.got, .dynbss, and
1102    .rela.bss sections in DYNOBJ, and set up shortcuts to them in our
1103    hash table.  */
1104 
1105 static bfd_boolean
1106 elf_x86_64_create_dynamic_sections (bfd *dynobj,
1107 				    struct bfd_link_info *info)
1108 {
1109   struct elf_x86_64_link_hash_table *htab;
1110 
1111   if (!_bfd_elf_create_dynamic_sections (dynobj, info))
1112     return FALSE;
1113 
1114   htab = elf_x86_64_hash_table (info);
1115   if (htab == NULL)
1116     return FALSE;
1117 
1118   /* Set the contents of the .interp section to the interpreter.  */
1119   if (bfd_link_executable (info) && !info->nointerp)
1120     {
1121       asection *s = bfd_get_linker_section (dynobj, ".interp");
1122       if (s == NULL)
1123 	abort ();
1124       s->size = htab->dynamic_interpreter_size;
1125       s->contents = (unsigned char *) htab->dynamic_interpreter;
1126       htab->interp = s;
1127     }
1128 
1129   htab->sdynbss = bfd_get_linker_section (dynobj, ".dynbss");
1130   if (!htab->sdynbss)
1131     abort ();
1132 
1133   if (bfd_link_executable (info))
1134     {
1135       /* Always allow copy relocs for building executables.  */
1136       asection *s = bfd_get_linker_section (dynobj, ".rela.bss");
1137       if (s == NULL)
1138 	{
1139 	  const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (dynobj);
1140 	  s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (dynobj,
1141 						  ".rela.bss",
1142 						  (bed->dynamic_sec_flags
1143 						   | SEC_READONLY));
1144 	  if (s == NULL
1145 	      || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (dynobj, s,
1146 					      bed->s->log_file_align))
1147 	    return FALSE;
1148 	}
1149       htab->srelbss = s;
1150     }
1151 
1152   if (!info->no_ld_generated_unwind_info
1153       && htab->plt_eh_frame == NULL
1154       && htab->elf.splt != NULL)
1155     {
1156       flagword flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY
1157 			| SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
1158 			| SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
1159       htab->plt_eh_frame
1160 	= bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (dynobj, ".eh_frame", flags);
1161       if (htab->plt_eh_frame == NULL
1162 	  || !bfd_set_section_alignment (dynobj, htab->plt_eh_frame, 3))
1163 	return FALSE;
1164     }
1165   return TRUE;
1166 }
1167 
1168 /* Copy the extra info we tack onto an elf_link_hash_entry.  */
1169 
1170 static void
1171 elf_x86_64_copy_indirect_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
1172 				 struct elf_link_hash_entry *dir,
1173 				 struct elf_link_hash_entry *ind)
1174 {
1175   struct elf_x86_64_link_hash_entry *edir, *eind;
1176 
1177   edir = (struct elf_x86_64_link_hash_entry *) dir;
1178   eind = (struct elf_x86_64_link_hash_entry *) ind;
1179 
1180   if (!edir->has_bnd_reloc)
1181     edir->has_bnd_reloc = eind->has_bnd_reloc;
1182 
1183   if (!edir->has_got_reloc)
1184     edir->has_got_reloc = eind->has_got_reloc;
1185 
1186   if (!edir->has_non_got_reloc)
1187     edir->has_non_got_reloc = eind->has_non_got_reloc;
1188 
1189   if (eind->dyn_relocs != NULL)
1190     {
1191       if (edir->dyn_relocs != NULL)
1192 	{
1193 	  struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
1194 	  struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
1195 
1196 	  /* Add reloc counts against the indirect sym to the direct sym
1197 	     list.  Merge any entries against the same section.  */
1198 	  for (pp = &eind->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
1199 	    {
1200 	      struct elf_dyn_relocs *q;
1201 
1202 	      for (q = edir->dyn_relocs; q != NULL; q = q->next)
1203 		if (q->sec == p->sec)
1204 		  {
1205 		    q->pc_count += p->pc_count;
1206 		    q->count += p->count;
1207 		    *pp = p->next;
1208 		    break;
1209 		  }
1210 	      if (q == NULL)
1211 		pp = &p->next;
1212 	    }
1213 	  *pp = edir->dyn_relocs;
1214 	}
1215 
1216       edir->dyn_relocs = eind->dyn_relocs;
1217       eind->dyn_relocs = NULL;
1218     }
1219 
1220   if (ind->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
1221       && dir->got.refcount <= 0)
1222     {
1223       edir->tls_type = eind->tls_type;
1224       eind->tls_type = GOT_UNKNOWN;
1225     }
1226 
1227   if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
1228       && ind->root.type != bfd_link_hash_indirect
1229       && dir->dynamic_adjusted)
1230     {
1231       /* If called to transfer flags for a weakdef during processing
1232 	 of elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol, don't copy non_got_ref.
1233 	 We clear it ourselves for ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS.  */
1234       dir->ref_dynamic |= ind->ref_dynamic;
1235       dir->ref_regular |= ind->ref_regular;
1236       dir->ref_regular_nonweak |= ind->ref_regular_nonweak;
1237       dir->needs_plt |= ind->needs_plt;
1238       dir->pointer_equality_needed |= ind->pointer_equality_needed;
1239     }
1240   else
1241     {
1242       if (eind->func_pointer_refcount > 0)
1243 	{
1244 	  edir->func_pointer_refcount += eind->func_pointer_refcount;
1245 	  eind->func_pointer_refcount = 0;
1246 	}
1247 
1248       _bfd_elf_link_hash_copy_indirect (info, dir, ind);
1249     }
1250 }
1251 
1252 static bfd_boolean
1253 elf64_x86_64_elf_object_p (bfd *abfd)
1254 {
1255   /* Set the right machine number for an x86-64 elf64 file.  */
1256   bfd_default_set_arch_mach (abfd, bfd_arch_i386, bfd_mach_x86_64);
1257   return TRUE;
1258 }
1259 
1260 static bfd_boolean
1261 elf32_x86_64_elf_object_p (bfd *abfd)
1262 {
1263   /* Set the right machine number for an x86-64 elf32 file.  */
1264   bfd_default_set_arch_mach (abfd, bfd_arch_i386, bfd_mach_x64_32);
1265   return TRUE;
1266 }
1267 
1268 /* Return TRUE if the TLS access code sequence support transition
1269    from R_TYPE.  */
1270 
1271 static bfd_boolean
1272 elf_x86_64_check_tls_transition (bfd *abfd,
1273 				 struct bfd_link_info *info,
1274 				 asection *sec,
1275 				 bfd_byte *contents,
1276 				 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
1277 				 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes,
1278 				 unsigned int r_type,
1279 				 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
1280 				 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relend)
1281 {
1282   unsigned int val;
1283   unsigned long r_symndx;
1284   bfd_boolean largepic = FALSE;
1285   struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
1286   bfd_vma offset;
1287   struct elf_x86_64_link_hash_table *htab;
1288   bfd_byte *call;
1289   bfd_boolean indirect_call, tls_get_addr;
1290 
1291   htab = elf_x86_64_hash_table (info);
1292   offset = rel->r_offset;
1293   switch (r_type)
1294     {
1295     case R_X86_64_TLSGD:
1296     case R_X86_64_TLSLD:
1297       if ((rel + 1) >= relend)
1298 	return FALSE;
1299 
1300       if (r_type == R_X86_64_TLSGD)
1301 	{
1302 	  /* Check transition from GD access model.  For 64bit, only
1303 		.byte 0x66; leaq foo@tlsgd(%rip), %rdi
1304 		.word 0x6666; rex64; call __tls_get_addr@PLT
1305 	     or
1306 		.byte 0x66; leaq foo@tlsgd(%rip), %rdi
1307 		.byte 0x66; rex64
1308 		call *__tls_get_addr@GOTPCREL(%rip)
1309 		which may be converted to
1310 		addr32 call __tls_get_addr
1311 	     can transit to different access model.  For 32bit, only
1312 		leaq foo@tlsgd(%rip), %rdi
1313 		.word 0x6666; rex64; call __tls_get_addr@PLT
1314 	     or
1315 		leaq foo@tlsgd(%rip), %rdi
1316 		.byte 0x66; rex64
1317 		call *__tls_get_addr@GOTPCREL(%rip)
1318 		which may be converted to
1319 		addr32 call __tls_get_addr
1320 	     can transit to different access model.  For largepic,
1321 	     we also support:
1322 	        leaq foo@tlsgd(%rip), %rdi
1323 	        movabsq $__tls_get_addr@pltoff, %rax
1324 	        addq $r15, %rax
1325 	        call *%rax
1326 	     or
1327 	        leaq foo@tlsgd(%rip), %rdi
1328 	        movabsq $__tls_get_addr@pltoff, %rax
1329 	        addq $rbx, %rax
1330 	        call *%rax  */
1331 
1332 	  static const unsigned char leaq[] = { 0x66, 0x48, 0x8d, 0x3d };
1333 
1334 	  if ((offset + 12) > sec->size)
1335 	    return FALSE;
1336 
1337 	  call = contents + offset + 4;
1338 	  if (call[0] != 0x66
1339 	      || !((call[1] == 0x48
1340 		    && call[2] == 0xff
1341 		    && call[3] == 0x15)
1342 		   || (call[1] == 0x48
1343 		       && call[2] == 0x67
1344 		       && call[3] == 0xe8)
1345 		   || (call[1] == 0x66
1346 		       && call[2] == 0x48
1347 		       && call[3] == 0xe8)))
1348 	    {
1349 	      if (!ABI_64_P (abfd)
1350 		  || (offset + 19) > sec->size
1351 		  || offset < 3
1352 		  || memcmp (call - 7, leaq + 1, 3) != 0
1353 		  || memcmp (call, "\x48\xb8", 2) != 0
1354 		  || call[11] != 0x01
1355 		  || call[13] != 0xff
1356 		  || call[14] != 0xd0
1357 		  || !((call[10] == 0x48 && call[12] == 0xd8)
1358 		       || (call[10] == 0x4c && call[12] == 0xf8)))
1359 		return FALSE;
1360 	      largepic = TRUE;
1361 	    }
1362 	  else if (ABI_64_P (abfd))
1363 	    {
1364 	      if (offset < 4
1365 		  || memcmp (contents + offset - 4, leaq, 4) != 0)
1366 		return FALSE;
1367 	    }
1368 	  else
1369 	    {
1370 	      if (offset < 3
1371 		  || memcmp (contents + offset - 3, leaq + 1, 3) != 0)
1372 		return FALSE;
1373 	    }
1374 	  indirect_call = call[2] == 0xff;
1375 	}
1376       else
1377 	{
1378 	  /* Check transition from LD access model.  Only
1379 		leaq foo@tlsld(%rip), %rdi;
1380 		call __tls_get_addr@PLT
1381              or
1382 		leaq foo@tlsld(%rip), %rdi;
1383 		call *__tls_get_addr@GOTPCREL(%rip)
1384 		which may be converted to
1385 		addr32 call __tls_get_addr
1386 	     can transit to different access model.  For largepic
1387 	     we also support:
1388 	        leaq foo@tlsld(%rip), %rdi
1389 	        movabsq $__tls_get_addr@pltoff, %rax
1390 	        addq $r15, %rax
1391 	        call *%rax
1392 	     or
1393 	        leaq foo@tlsld(%rip), %rdi
1394 	        movabsq $__tls_get_addr@pltoff, %rax
1395 	        addq $rbx, %rax
1396 	        call *%rax  */
1397 
1398 	  static const unsigned char lea[] = { 0x48, 0x8d, 0x3d };
1399 
1400 	  if (offset < 3 || (offset + 9) > sec->size)
1401 	    return FALSE;
1402 
1403 	  if (memcmp (contents + offset - 3, lea, 3) != 0)
1404 	    return FALSE;
1405 
1406 	  call = contents + offset + 4;
1407 	  if (!(call[0] == 0xe8
1408 		|| (call[0] == 0xff && call[1] == 0x15)
1409 		|| (call[0] == 0x67 && call[1] == 0xe8)))
1410 	    {
1411 	      if (!ABI_64_P (abfd)
1412 		  || (offset + 19) > sec->size
1413 		  || memcmp (call, "\x48\xb8", 2) != 0
1414 		  || call[11] != 0x01
1415 		  || call[13] != 0xff
1416 		  || call[14] != 0xd0
1417 		  || !((call[10] == 0x48 && call[12] == 0xd8)
1418 		       || (call[10] == 0x4c && call[12] == 0xf8)))
1419 		return FALSE;
1420 	      largepic = TRUE;
1421 	    }
1422 	  indirect_call = call[0] == 0xff;
1423 	}
1424 
1425       r_symndx = htab->r_sym (rel[1].r_info);
1426       if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
1427 	return FALSE;
1428 
1429       tls_get_addr = FALSE;
1430       h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
1431       if (h != NULL && h->root.root.string != NULL)
1432 	{
1433 	  struct elf_x86_64_link_hash_entry *eh
1434 	    = (struct elf_x86_64_link_hash_entry *) h;
1435 	  tls_get_addr = eh->tls_get_addr == 1;
1436 	  if (eh->tls_get_addr > 1)
1437 	    {
1438 	      /* Use strncmp to check __tls_get_addr since
1439 		 __tls_get_addr may be versioned.  */
1440 	      if (strncmp (h->root.root.string, "__tls_get_addr", 14)
1441 		  == 0)
1442 		{
1443 		  eh->tls_get_addr = 1;
1444 		  tls_get_addr = TRUE;
1445 		}
1446 	      else
1447 		eh->tls_get_addr = 0;
1448 	    }
1449 	}
1450 
1451       if (!tls_get_addr)
1452 	return FALSE;
1453       else if (largepic)
1454 	return ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) == R_X86_64_PLTOFF64;
1455       else if (indirect_call)
1456 	return ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) == R_X86_64_GOTPCRELX;
1457       else
1458 	return (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) == R_X86_64_PC32
1459 		|| ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) == R_X86_64_PLT32);
1460 
1461     case R_X86_64_GOTTPOFF:
1462       /* Check transition from IE access model:
1463 		mov foo@gottpoff(%rip), %reg
1464 		add foo@gottpoff(%rip), %reg
1465        */
1466 
1467       /* Check REX prefix first.  */
1468       if (offset >= 3 && (offset + 4) <= sec->size)
1469 	{
1470 	  val = bfd_get_8 (abfd, contents + offset - 3);
1471 	  if (val != 0x48 && val != 0x4c)
1472 	    {
1473 	      /* X32 may have 0x44 REX prefix or no REX prefix.  */
1474 	      if (ABI_64_P (abfd))
1475 		return FALSE;
1476 	    }
1477 	}
1478       else
1479 	{
1480 	  /* X32 may not have any REX prefix.  */
1481 	  if (ABI_64_P (abfd))
1482 	    return FALSE;
1483 	  if (offset < 2 || (offset + 3) > sec->size)
1484 	    return FALSE;
1485 	}
1486 
1487       val = bfd_get_8 (abfd, contents + offset - 2);
1488       if (val != 0x8b && val != 0x03)
1489 	return FALSE;
1490 
1491       val = bfd_get_8 (abfd, contents + offset - 1);
1492       return (val & 0xc7) == 5;
1493 
1494     case R_X86_64_GOTPC32_TLSDESC:
1495       /* Check transition from GDesc access model:
1496 		leaq x@tlsdesc(%rip), %rax
1497 
1498 	 Make sure it's a leaq adding rip to a 32-bit offset
1499 	 into any register, although it's probably almost always
1500 	 going to be rax.  */
1501 
1502       if (offset < 3 || (offset + 4) > sec->size)
1503 	return FALSE;
1504 
1505       val = bfd_get_8 (abfd, contents + offset - 3);
1506       if ((val & 0xfb) != 0x48)
1507 	return FALSE;
1508 
1509       if (bfd_get_8 (abfd, contents + offset - 2) != 0x8d)
1510 	return FALSE;
1511 
1512       val = bfd_get_8 (abfd, contents + offset - 1);
1513       return (val & 0xc7) == 0x05;
1514 
1515     case R_X86_64_TLSDESC_CALL:
1516       /* Check transition from GDesc access model:
1517 		call *x@tlsdesc(%rax)
1518        */
1519       if (offset + 2 <= sec->size)
1520 	{
1521 	  /* Make sure that it's a call *x@tlsdesc(%rax).  */
1522 	  call = contents + offset;
1523 	  return call[0] == 0xff && call[1] == 0x10;
1524 	}
1525 
1526       return FALSE;
1527 
1528     default:
1529       abort ();
1530     }
1531 }
1532 
1533 /* Return TRUE if the TLS access transition is OK or no transition
1534    will be performed.  Update R_TYPE if there is a transition.  */
1535 
1536 static bfd_boolean
1537 elf_x86_64_tls_transition (struct bfd_link_info *info, bfd *abfd,
1538 			   asection *sec, bfd_byte *contents,
1539 			   Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
1540 			   struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes,
1541 			   unsigned int *r_type, int tls_type,
1542 			   const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
1543 			   const Elf_Internal_Rela *relend,
1544 			   struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
1545 			   unsigned long r_symndx,
1546 			   bfd_boolean from_relocate_section)
1547 {
1548   unsigned int from_type = *r_type;
1549   unsigned int to_type = from_type;
1550   bfd_boolean check = TRUE;
1551 
1552   /* Skip TLS transition for functions.  */
1553   if (h != NULL
1554       && (h->type == STT_FUNC
1555 	  || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC))
1556     return TRUE;
1557 
1558   switch (from_type)
1559     {
1560     case R_X86_64_TLSGD:
1561     case R_X86_64_GOTPC32_TLSDESC:
1562     case R_X86_64_TLSDESC_CALL:
1563     case R_X86_64_GOTTPOFF:
1564       if (bfd_link_executable (info))
1565 	{
1566 	  if (h == NULL)
1567 	    to_type = R_X86_64_TPOFF32;
1568 	  else
1569 	    to_type = R_X86_64_GOTTPOFF;
1570 	}
1571 
1572       /* When we are called from elf_x86_64_relocate_section, there may
1573 	 be additional transitions based on TLS_TYPE.  */
1574       if (from_relocate_section)
1575 	{
1576 	  unsigned int new_to_type = to_type;
1577 
1578 	  if (bfd_link_executable (info)
1579 	      && h != NULL
1580 	      && h->dynindx == -1
1581 	      && tls_type == GOT_TLS_IE)
1582 	    new_to_type = R_X86_64_TPOFF32;
1583 
1584 	  if (to_type == R_X86_64_TLSGD
1585 	      || to_type == R_X86_64_GOTPC32_TLSDESC
1586 	      || to_type == R_X86_64_TLSDESC_CALL)
1587 	    {
1588 	      if (tls_type == GOT_TLS_IE)
1589 		new_to_type = R_X86_64_GOTTPOFF;
1590 	    }
1591 
1592 	  /* We checked the transition before when we were called from
1593 	     elf_x86_64_check_relocs.  We only want to check the new
1594 	     transition which hasn't been checked before.  */
1595 	  check = new_to_type != to_type && from_type == to_type;
1596 	  to_type = new_to_type;
1597 	}
1598 
1599       break;
1600 
1601     case R_X86_64_TLSLD:
1602       if (bfd_link_executable (info))
1603 	to_type = R_X86_64_TPOFF32;
1604       break;
1605 
1606     default:
1607       return TRUE;
1608     }
1609 
1610   /* Return TRUE if there is no transition.  */
1611   if (from_type == to_type)
1612     return TRUE;
1613 
1614   /* Check if the transition can be performed.  */
1615   if (check
1616       && ! elf_x86_64_check_tls_transition (abfd, info, sec, contents,
1617 					    symtab_hdr, sym_hashes,
1618 					    from_type, rel, relend))
1619     {
1620       reloc_howto_type *from, *to;
1621       const char *name;
1622 
1623       from = elf_x86_64_rtype_to_howto (abfd, from_type);
1624       to = elf_x86_64_rtype_to_howto (abfd, to_type);
1625 
1626       if (h)
1627 	name = h->root.root.string;
1628       else
1629 	{
1630 	  struct elf_x86_64_link_hash_table *htab;
1631 
1632 	  htab = elf_x86_64_hash_table (info);
1633 	  if (htab == NULL)
1634 	    name = "*unknown*";
1635 	  else
1636 	    {
1637 	      Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
1638 
1639 	      isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->sym_cache,
1640 					    abfd, r_symndx);
1641 	      name = bfd_elf_sym_name (abfd, symtab_hdr, isym, NULL);
1642 	    }
1643 	}
1644 
1645       (*_bfd_error_handler)
1646 	(_("%B: TLS transition from %s to %s against `%s' at 0x%lx "
1647 	   "in section `%A' failed"),
1648 	 abfd, sec, from->name, to->name, name,
1649 	 (unsigned long) rel->r_offset);
1650       bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
1651       return FALSE;
1652     }
1653 
1654   *r_type = to_type;
1655   return TRUE;
1656 }
1657 
1658 /* Rename some of the generic section flags to better document how they
1659    are used here.  */
1660 #define need_convert_load	sec_flg0
1661 #define check_relocs_failed	sec_flg1
1662 
1663 static bfd_boolean
1664 elf_x86_64_need_pic (bfd *input_bfd, asection *sec,
1665 		     struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
1666 		     Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
1667 		     Elf_Internal_Sym *isym,
1668 		     reloc_howto_type *howto)
1669 {
1670   const char *v = "";
1671   const char *und = "";
1672   const char *pic = "";
1673 
1674   const char *name;
1675   if (h)
1676     {
1677       name = h->root.root.string;
1678       switch (ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other))
1679 	{
1680 	case STV_HIDDEN:
1681 	  v = _("hidden symbol ");
1682 	  break;
1683 	case STV_INTERNAL:
1684 	  v = _("internal symbol ");
1685 	  break;
1686 	case STV_PROTECTED:
1687 	  v = _("protected symbol ");
1688 	  break;
1689 	default:
1690 	  v = _("symbol ");
1691 	  pic = _("; recompile with -fPIC");
1692 	  break;
1693 	}
1694 
1695       if (!h->def_regular && !h->def_dynamic)
1696 	und = _("undefined ");
1697     }
1698   else
1699     {
1700       name = bfd_elf_sym_name (input_bfd, symtab_hdr, isym, NULL);
1701       pic = _("; recompile with -fPIC");
1702     }
1703 
1704   (*_bfd_error_handler) (_("%B: relocation %s against %s%s`%s' can "
1705 			   "not be used when making a shared object%s"),
1706 			 input_bfd, howto->name, und, v, name, pic);
1707   bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
1708   sec->check_relocs_failed = 1;
1709   return FALSE;
1710 }
1711 
1712 /* With the local symbol, foo, we convert
1713    mov foo@GOTPCREL(%rip), %reg
1714    to
1715    lea foo(%rip), %reg
1716    and convert
1717    call/jmp *foo@GOTPCREL(%rip)
1718    to
1719    nop call foo/jmp foo nop
1720    When PIC is false, convert
1721    test %reg, foo@GOTPCREL(%rip)
1722    to
1723    test $foo, %reg
1724    and convert
1725    binop foo@GOTPCREL(%rip), %reg
1726    to
1727    binop $foo, %reg
1728    where binop is one of adc, add, and, cmp, or, sbb, sub, xor
1729    instructions.  */
1730 
1731 static bfd_boolean
1732 elf_x86_64_convert_load_reloc (bfd *abfd, asection *sec,
1733 			       bfd_byte *contents,
1734 			       Elf_Internal_Rela *irel,
1735 			       struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
1736 			       bfd_boolean *converted,
1737 			       struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
1738 {
1739   struct elf_x86_64_link_hash_table *htab;
1740   bfd_boolean is_pic;
1741   bfd_boolean require_reloc_pc32;
1742   bfd_boolean relocx;
1743   bfd_boolean to_reloc_pc32;
1744   asection *tsec;
1745   char symtype;
1746   bfd_signed_vma raddend;
1747   unsigned int opcode;
1748   unsigned int modrm;
1749   unsigned int r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info);
1750   unsigned int r_symndx;
1751   bfd_vma toff;
1752   bfd_vma roff = irel->r_offset;
1753 
1754   if (roff < (r_type == R_X86_64_REX_GOTPCRELX ? 3 : 2))
1755     return TRUE;
1756 
1757   raddend = irel->r_addend;
1758   /* Addend for 32-bit PC-relative relocation must be -4.  */
1759   if (raddend != -4)
1760     return TRUE;
1761 
1762   htab = elf_x86_64_hash_table (link_info);
1763   is_pic = bfd_link_pic (link_info);
1764 
1765   relocx = (r_type == R_X86_64_GOTPCRELX
1766 	    || r_type == R_X86_64_REX_GOTPCRELX);
1767 
1768   /* TRUE if we can convert only to R_X86_64_PC32.  Enable it for
1769      --no-relax.  */
1770   require_reloc_pc32
1771     = link_info->disable_target_specific_optimizations > 1;
1772 
1773   r_symndx = htab->r_sym (irel->r_info);
1774 
1775   opcode = bfd_get_8 (abfd, contents + roff - 2);
1776 
1777   /* Convert mov to lea since it has been done for a while.  */
1778   if (opcode != 0x8b)
1779     {
1780       /* Only convert R_X86_64_GOTPCRELX and R_X86_64_REX_GOTPCRELX
1781 	 for call, jmp or one of adc, add, and, cmp, or, sbb, sub,
1782 	 test, xor instructions.  */
1783       if (!relocx)
1784 	return TRUE;
1785     }
1786 
1787   /* We convert only to R_X86_64_PC32:
1788      1. Branch.
1789      2. R_X86_64_GOTPCREL since we can't modify REX byte.
1790      3. require_reloc_pc32 is true.
1791      4. PIC.
1792      */
1793   to_reloc_pc32 = (opcode == 0xff
1794 		   || !relocx
1795 		   || require_reloc_pc32
1796 		   || is_pic);
1797 
1798   /* Get the symbol referred to by the reloc.  */
1799   if (h == NULL)
1800     {
1801       Elf_Internal_Sym *isym
1802 	= bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->sym_cache, abfd, r_symndx);
1803 
1804       /* Skip relocation against undefined symbols.  */
1805       if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_UNDEF)
1806 	return TRUE;
1807 
1808       symtype = ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info);
1809 
1810       if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_ABS)
1811 	tsec = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
1812       else if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_COMMON)
1813 	tsec = bfd_com_section_ptr;
1814       else if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_X86_64_LCOMMON)
1815 	tsec = &_bfd_elf_large_com_section;
1816       else
1817 	tsec = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx);
1818 
1819       toff = isym->st_value;
1820     }
1821   else
1822     {
1823       /* Undefined weak symbol is only bound locally in executable
1824 	 and its reference is resolved as 0 without relocation
1825 	 overflow.  We can only perform this optimization for
1826 	 GOTPCRELX relocations since we need to modify REX byte.
1827 	 It is OK convert mov with R_X86_64_GOTPCREL to
1828 	 R_X86_64_PC32.  */
1829       if ((relocx || opcode == 0x8b)
1830 	  && UNDEFINED_WEAK_RESOLVED_TO_ZERO (link_info,
1831 					      TRUE,
1832 					      elf_x86_64_hash_entry (h)))
1833 	{
1834 	  if (opcode == 0xff)
1835 	    {
1836 	      /* Skip for branch instructions since R_X86_64_PC32
1837 		 may overflow.  */
1838 	      if (require_reloc_pc32)
1839 		return TRUE;
1840 	    }
1841 	  else if (relocx)
1842 	    {
1843 	      /* For non-branch instructions, we can convert to
1844 		 R_X86_64_32/R_X86_64_32S since we know if there
1845 		 is a REX byte.  */
1846 	      to_reloc_pc32 = FALSE;
1847 	    }
1848 
1849 	  /* Since we don't know the current PC when PIC is true,
1850 	     we can't convert to R_X86_64_PC32.  */
1851 	  if (to_reloc_pc32 && is_pic)
1852 	    return TRUE;
1853 
1854 	  goto convert;
1855 	}
1856       /* Avoid optimizing GOTPCREL relocations againt _DYNAMIC since
1857 	 ld.so may use its link-time address.  */
1858       else if ((h->def_regular
1859 		|| h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
1860 		|| h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
1861 	       && h != htab->elf.hdynamic
1862 	       && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (link_info, h))
1863 	{
1864 	  /* bfd_link_hash_new or bfd_link_hash_undefined is
1865 	     set by an assignment in a linker script in
1866 	     bfd_elf_record_link_assignment.   */
1867 	  if (h->def_regular
1868 	      && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new
1869 		  || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined))
1870 	    {
1871 	      /* Skip since R_X86_64_32/R_X86_64_32S may overflow.  */
1872 	      if (require_reloc_pc32)
1873 		return TRUE;
1874 	      goto convert;
1875 	    }
1876 	  tsec = h->root.u.def.section;
1877 	  toff = h->root.u.def.value;
1878 	  symtype = h->type;
1879 	}
1880       else
1881 	return TRUE;
1882     }
1883 
1884   /* Don't convert GOTPCREL relocation against large section.  */
1885   if (elf_section_data (tsec) !=  NULL
1886       && (elf_section_flags (tsec) & SHF_X86_64_LARGE) != 0)
1887     return TRUE;
1888 
1889   /* We can only estimate relocation overflow for R_X86_64_PC32.  */
1890   if (!to_reloc_pc32)
1891     goto convert;
1892 
1893   if (tsec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_MERGE)
1894     {
1895       /* At this stage in linking, no SEC_MERGE symbol has been
1896 	 adjusted, so all references to such symbols need to be
1897 	 passed through _bfd_merged_section_offset.  (Later, in
1898 	 relocate_section, all SEC_MERGE symbols *except* for
1899 	 section symbols have been adjusted.)
1900 
1901 	 gas may reduce relocations against symbols in SEC_MERGE
1902 	 sections to a relocation against the section symbol when
1903 	 the original addend was zero.  When the reloc is against
1904 	 a section symbol we should include the addend in the
1905 	 offset passed to _bfd_merged_section_offset, since the
1906 	 location of interest is the original symbol.  On the
1907 	 other hand, an access to "sym+addend" where "sym" is not
1908 	 a section symbol should not include the addend;  Such an
1909 	 access is presumed to be an offset from "sym";  The
1910 	 location of interest is just "sym".  */
1911       if (symtype == STT_SECTION)
1912 	toff += raddend;
1913 
1914       toff = _bfd_merged_section_offset (abfd, &tsec,
1915 					 elf_section_data (tsec)->sec_info,
1916 					 toff);
1917 
1918       if (symtype != STT_SECTION)
1919 	toff += raddend;
1920     }
1921   else
1922     toff += raddend;
1923 
1924   /* Don't convert if R_X86_64_PC32 relocation overflows.  */
1925   if (tsec->output_section == sec->output_section)
1926     {
1927       if ((toff - roff + 0x80000000) > 0xffffffff)
1928 	return TRUE;
1929     }
1930   else
1931     {
1932       bfd_signed_vma distance;
1933 
1934       /* At this point, we don't know the load addresses of TSEC
1935 	 section nor SEC section.  We estimate the distrance between
1936 	 SEC and TSEC.  We store the estimated distances in the
1937 	 compressed_size field of the output section, which is only
1938 	 used to decompress the compressed input section.  */
1939       if (sec->output_section->compressed_size == 0)
1940 	{
1941 	  asection *asect;
1942 	  bfd_size_type size = 0;
1943 	  for (asect = link_info->output_bfd->sections;
1944 	       asect != NULL;
1945 	       asect = asect->next)
1946 	    /* Skip debug sections since compressed_size is used to
1947 	       compress debug sections.  */
1948 	    if ((asect->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING) == 0)
1949 	      {
1950 		asection *i;
1951 		for (i = asect->map_head.s;
1952 		     i != NULL;
1953 		     i = i->map_head.s)
1954 		  {
1955 		    size = align_power (size, i->alignment_power);
1956 		    size += i->size;
1957 		  }
1958 		asect->compressed_size = size;
1959 	      }
1960 	}
1961 
1962       /* Don't convert GOTPCREL relocations if TSEC isn't placed
1963 	 after SEC.  */
1964       distance = (tsec->output_section->compressed_size
1965 		  - sec->output_section->compressed_size);
1966       if (distance < 0)
1967 	return TRUE;
1968 
1969       /* Take PT_GNU_RELRO segment into account by adding
1970 	 maxpagesize.  */
1971       if ((toff + distance + get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->maxpagesize
1972 	   - roff + 0x80000000) > 0xffffffff)
1973 	return TRUE;
1974     }
1975 
1976 convert:
1977   if (opcode == 0xff)
1978     {
1979       /* We have "call/jmp *foo@GOTPCREL(%rip)".  */
1980       unsigned int nop;
1981       unsigned int disp;
1982       bfd_vma nop_offset;
1983 
1984       /* Convert R_X86_64_GOTPCRELX and R_X86_64_REX_GOTPCRELX to
1985 	 R_X86_64_PC32.  */
1986       modrm = bfd_get_8 (abfd, contents + roff - 1);
1987       if (modrm == 0x25)
1988 	{
1989 	  /* Convert to "jmp foo nop".  */
1990 	  modrm = 0xe9;
1991 	  nop = NOP_OPCODE;
1992 	  nop_offset = irel->r_offset + 3;
1993 	  disp = bfd_get_32 (abfd, contents + irel->r_offset);
1994 	  irel->r_offset -= 1;
1995 	  bfd_put_32 (abfd, disp, contents + irel->r_offset);
1996 	}
1997       else
1998 	{
1999 	  struct elf_x86_64_link_hash_entry *eh
2000 	    = (struct elf_x86_64_link_hash_entry *) h;
2001 
2002 	  /* Convert to "nop call foo".  ADDR_PREFIX_OPCODE
2003 	     is a nop prefix.  */
2004 	  modrm = 0xe8;
2005 	  /* To support TLS optimization, always use addr32 prefix for
2006 	     "call *__tls_get_addr@GOTPCREL(%rip)".  */
2007 	  if (eh && eh->tls_get_addr == 1)
2008 	    {
2009 	      nop = 0x67;
2010 	      nop_offset = irel->r_offset - 2;
2011 	    }
2012 	  else
2013 	    {
2014 	      nop = link_info->call_nop_byte;
2015 	      if (link_info->call_nop_as_suffix)
2016 		{
2017 		  nop_offset = irel->r_offset + 3;
2018 		  disp = bfd_get_32 (abfd, contents + irel->r_offset);
2019 		  irel->r_offset -= 1;
2020 		  bfd_put_32 (abfd, disp, contents + irel->r_offset);
2021 		}
2022 	      else
2023 		nop_offset = irel->r_offset - 2;
2024 	    }
2025 	}
2026       bfd_put_8 (abfd, nop, contents + nop_offset);
2027       bfd_put_8 (abfd, modrm, contents + irel->r_offset - 1);
2028       r_type = R_X86_64_PC32;
2029     }
2030   else
2031     {
2032       unsigned int rex;
2033       unsigned int rex_mask = REX_R;
2034 
2035       if (r_type == R_X86_64_REX_GOTPCRELX)
2036 	rex = bfd_get_8 (abfd, contents + roff - 3);
2037       else
2038 	rex = 0;
2039 
2040       if (opcode == 0x8b)
2041 	{
2042 	  if (to_reloc_pc32)
2043 	    {
2044 	      /* Convert "mov foo@GOTPCREL(%rip), %reg" to
2045 		 "lea foo(%rip), %reg".  */
2046 	      opcode = 0x8d;
2047 	      r_type = R_X86_64_PC32;
2048 	    }
2049 	  else
2050 	    {
2051 	      /* Convert "mov foo@GOTPCREL(%rip), %reg" to
2052 		 "mov $foo, %reg".  */
2053 	      opcode = 0xc7;
2054 	      modrm = bfd_get_8 (abfd, contents + roff - 1);
2055 	      modrm = 0xc0 | (modrm & 0x38) >> 3;
2056 	      if ((rex & REX_W) != 0
2057 		  && ABI_64_P (link_info->output_bfd))
2058 		{
2059 		  /* Keep the REX_W bit in REX byte for LP64.  */
2060 		  r_type = R_X86_64_32S;
2061 		  goto rewrite_modrm_rex;
2062 		}
2063 	      else
2064 		{
2065 		  /* If the REX_W bit in REX byte isn't needed,
2066 		     use R_X86_64_32 and clear the W bit to avoid
2067 		     sign-extend imm32 to imm64.  */
2068 		  r_type = R_X86_64_32;
2069 		  /* Clear the W bit in REX byte.  */
2070 		  rex_mask |= REX_W;
2071 		  goto rewrite_modrm_rex;
2072 		}
2073 	    }
2074 	}
2075       else
2076 	{
2077 	  /* R_X86_64_PC32 isn't supported.  */
2078 	  if (to_reloc_pc32)
2079 	    return TRUE;
2080 
2081 	  modrm = bfd_get_8 (abfd, contents + roff - 1);
2082 	  if (opcode == 0x85)
2083 	    {
2084 	      /* Convert "test %reg, foo@GOTPCREL(%rip)" to
2085 		 "test $foo, %reg".  */
2086 	      modrm = 0xc0 | (modrm & 0x38) >> 3;
2087 	      opcode = 0xf7;
2088 	    }
2089 	  else
2090 	    {
2091 	      /* Convert "binop foo@GOTPCREL(%rip), %reg" to
2092 		 "binop $foo, %reg".  */
2093 	      modrm = 0xc0 | (modrm & 0x38) >> 3 | (opcode & 0x3c);
2094 	      opcode = 0x81;
2095 	    }
2096 
2097 	  /* Use R_X86_64_32 with 32-bit operand to avoid relocation
2098 	     overflow when sign-extending imm32 to imm64.  */
2099 	  r_type = (rex & REX_W) != 0 ? R_X86_64_32S : R_X86_64_32;
2100 
2101 rewrite_modrm_rex:
2102 	  bfd_put_8 (abfd, modrm, contents + roff - 1);
2103 
2104 	  if (rex)
2105 	    {
2106 	      /* Move the R bit to the B bit in REX byte.  */
2107 	      rex = (rex & ~rex_mask) | (rex & REX_R) >> 2;
2108 	      bfd_put_8 (abfd, rex, contents + roff - 3);
2109 	    }
2110 
2111 	  /* No addend for R_X86_64_32/R_X86_64_32S relocations.  */
2112 	  irel->r_addend = 0;
2113 	}
2114 
2115       bfd_put_8 (abfd, opcode, contents + roff - 2);
2116     }
2117 
2118   irel->r_info = htab->r_info (r_symndx, r_type);
2119 
2120   *converted = TRUE;
2121 
2122   return TRUE;
2123 }
2124 
2125 /* Look through the relocs for a section during the first phase, and
2126    calculate needed space in the global offset table, procedure
2127    linkage table, and dynamic reloc sections.  */
2128 
2129 static bfd_boolean
2130 elf_x86_64_check_relocs (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
2131 			 asection *sec,
2132 			 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs)
2133 {
2134   struct elf_x86_64_link_hash_table *htab;
2135   Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
2136   struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
2137   const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
2138   const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel_end;
2139   asection *sreloc;
2140   bfd_byte *contents;
2141   bfd_boolean use_plt_got;
2142 
2143   if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
2144     return TRUE;
2145 
2146   /* Don't do anything special with non-loaded, non-alloced sections.
2147      In particular, any relocs in such sections should not affect GOT
2148      and PLT reference counting (ie. we don't allow them to create GOT
2149      or PLT entries), there's no possibility or desire to optimize TLS
2150      relocs, and there's not much point in propagating relocs to shared
2151      libs that the dynamic linker won't relocate.  */
2152   if ((sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0)
2153     return TRUE;
2154 
2155   BFD_ASSERT (is_x86_64_elf (abfd));
2156 
2157   htab = elf_x86_64_hash_table (info);
2158   if (htab == NULL)
2159     {
2160       sec->check_relocs_failed = 1;
2161       return FALSE;
2162     }
2163 
2164   /* Get the section contents.  */
2165   if (elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents != NULL)
2166     contents = elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents;
2167   else if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, sec, &contents))
2168     {
2169       sec->check_relocs_failed = 1;
2170       return FALSE;
2171     }
2172 
2173   use_plt_got = get_elf_x86_64_backend_data (abfd) == &elf_x86_64_arch_bed;
2174 
2175   symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
2176   sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (abfd);
2177 
2178   sreloc = NULL;
2179 
2180   rel_end = relocs + sec->reloc_count;
2181   for (rel = relocs; rel < rel_end; rel++)
2182     {
2183       unsigned int r_type;
2184       unsigned long r_symndx;
2185       struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
2186       struct elf_x86_64_link_hash_entry *eh;
2187       Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
2188       const char *name;
2189       bfd_boolean size_reloc;
2190 
2191       r_symndx = htab->r_sym (rel->r_info);
2192       r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
2193 
2194       if (r_symndx >= NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (symtab_hdr))
2195 	{
2196 	  (*_bfd_error_handler) (_("%B: bad symbol index: %d"),
2197 				 abfd, r_symndx);
2198 	  goto error_return;
2199 	}
2200 
2201       if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
2202 	{
2203 	  /* A local symbol.  */
2204 	  isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->sym_cache,
2205 					abfd, r_symndx);
2206 	  if (isym == NULL)
2207 	    goto error_return;
2208 
2209 	  /* Check relocation against local STT_GNU_IFUNC symbol.  */
2210 	  if (ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
2211 	    {
2212 	      h = elf_x86_64_get_local_sym_hash (htab, abfd, rel,
2213 						 TRUE);
2214 	      if (h == NULL)
2215 		goto error_return;
2216 
2217 	      /* Fake a STT_GNU_IFUNC symbol.  */
2218 	      h->type = STT_GNU_IFUNC;
2219 	      h->def_regular = 1;
2220 	      h->ref_regular = 1;
2221 	      h->forced_local = 1;
2222 	      h->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
2223 	    }
2224 	  else
2225 	    h = NULL;
2226 	}
2227       else
2228 	{
2229 	  isym = NULL;
2230 	  h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
2231 	  while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
2232 		 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
2233 	    h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
2234 	}
2235 
2236       /* Check invalid x32 relocations.  */
2237       if (!ABI_64_P (abfd))
2238 	switch (r_type)
2239 	  {
2240 	  default:
2241 	    break;
2242 
2243 	  case R_X86_64_DTPOFF64:
2244 	  case R_X86_64_TPOFF64:
2245 	  case R_X86_64_PC64:
2246 	  case R_X86_64_GOTOFF64:
2247 	  case R_X86_64_GOT64:
2248 	  case R_X86_64_GOTPCREL64:
2249 	  case R_X86_64_GOTPC64:
2250 	  case R_X86_64_GOTPLT64:
2251 	  case R_X86_64_PLTOFF64:
2252 	      {
2253 		if (h)
2254 		  name = h->root.root.string;
2255 		else
2256 		  name = bfd_elf_sym_name (abfd, symtab_hdr, isym,
2257 					   NULL);
2258 		(*_bfd_error_handler)
2259 		  (_("%B: relocation %s against symbol `%s' isn't "
2260 		     "supported in x32 mode"), abfd,
2261 		   x86_64_elf_howto_table[r_type].name, name);
2262 		bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
2263 		goto error_return;
2264 	      }
2265 	    break;
2266 	  }
2267 
2268       if (h != NULL)
2269 	{
2270 	  switch (r_type)
2271 	    {
2272 	    default:
2273 	      break;
2274 
2275 	    case R_X86_64_PC32_BND:
2276 	    case R_X86_64_PLT32_BND:
2277 	    case R_X86_64_PC32:
2278 	    case R_X86_64_PLT32:
2279 	    case R_X86_64_32:
2280 	    case R_X86_64_64:
2281 	      /* MPX PLT is supported only if elf_x86_64_arch_bed
2282 		 is used in 64-bit mode.  */
2283 	      if (ABI_64_P (abfd)
2284 		      && info->bndplt
2285 		      && (get_elf_x86_64_backend_data (abfd)
2286 			  == &elf_x86_64_arch_bed))
2287 		{
2288 		  elf_x86_64_hash_entry (h)->has_bnd_reloc = 1;
2289 
2290 		  /* Create the second PLT for Intel MPX support.  */
2291 		  if (htab->plt_bnd == NULL)
2292 		    {
2293 		      unsigned int plt_bnd_align;
2294 		      const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
2295 
2296 		      bed = get_elf_backend_data (info->output_bfd);
2297 		      BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (elf_x86_64_bnd_plt2_entry) == 8
2298 				  && (sizeof (elf_x86_64_bnd_plt2_entry)
2299 				      == sizeof (elf_x86_64_legacy_plt2_entry)));
2300 		      plt_bnd_align = 3;
2301 
2302 		      if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
2303 			htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
2304 		      htab->plt_bnd
2305 			= bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (htab->elf.dynobj,
2306 							      ".plt.bnd",
2307 							     (bed->dynamic_sec_flags
2308 							      | SEC_ALLOC
2309 							      | SEC_CODE
2310 							      | SEC_LOAD
2311 							      | SEC_READONLY));
2312 		      if (htab->plt_bnd == NULL
2313 			  || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->elf.dynobj,
2314 							 htab->plt_bnd,
2315 							 plt_bnd_align))
2316 			goto error_return;
2317 		    }
2318 		}
2319 
2320 	    case R_X86_64_32S:
2321 	    case R_X86_64_PC64:
2322 	    case R_X86_64_GOTPCREL:
2323 	    case R_X86_64_GOTPCRELX:
2324 	    case R_X86_64_REX_GOTPCRELX:
2325 	    case R_X86_64_GOTPCREL64:
2326 	      if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
2327 		htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
2328 	      /* Create the ifunc sections for static executables.  */
2329 	      if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
2330 		  && !_bfd_elf_create_ifunc_sections (htab->elf.dynobj,
2331 						      info))
2332 		goto error_return;
2333 	      break;
2334 	    }
2335 
2336 	  /* It is referenced by a non-shared object. */
2337 	  h->ref_regular = 1;
2338 	  h->root.non_ir_ref = 1;
2339 
2340 	  if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
2341 	    elf_tdata (info->output_bfd)->has_gnu_symbols
2342 	      |= elf_gnu_symbol_ifunc;
2343 	}
2344 
2345       if (! elf_x86_64_tls_transition (info, abfd, sec, contents,
2346 				       symtab_hdr, sym_hashes,
2347 				       &r_type, GOT_UNKNOWN,
2348 				       rel, rel_end, h, r_symndx, FALSE))
2349 	goto error_return;
2350 
2351       eh = (struct elf_x86_64_link_hash_entry *) h;
2352       switch (r_type)
2353 	{
2354 	case R_X86_64_TLSLD:
2355 	  htab->tls_ld_got.refcount += 1;
2356 	  goto create_got;
2357 
2358 	case R_X86_64_TPOFF32:
2359 	  if (!bfd_link_executable (info) && ABI_64_P (abfd))
2360 	    return elf_x86_64_need_pic (abfd, sec, h, symtab_hdr, isym,
2361 					&x86_64_elf_howto_table[r_type]);
2362 	  if (eh != NULL)
2363 	    eh->has_got_reloc = 1;
2364 	  break;
2365 
2366 	case R_X86_64_GOTTPOFF:
2367 	  if (!bfd_link_executable (info))
2368 	    info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
2369 	  /* Fall through */
2370 
2371 	case R_X86_64_GOT32:
2372 	case R_X86_64_GOTPCREL:
2373 	case R_X86_64_GOTPCRELX:
2374 	case R_X86_64_REX_GOTPCRELX:
2375 	case R_X86_64_TLSGD:
2376 	case R_X86_64_GOT64:
2377 	case R_X86_64_GOTPCREL64:
2378 	case R_X86_64_GOTPLT64:
2379 	case R_X86_64_GOTPC32_TLSDESC:
2380 	case R_X86_64_TLSDESC_CALL:
2381 	  /* This symbol requires a global offset table entry.	*/
2382 	  {
2383 	    int tls_type, old_tls_type;
2384 
2385 	    switch (r_type)
2386 	      {
2387 	      default: tls_type = GOT_NORMAL; break;
2388 	      case R_X86_64_TLSGD: tls_type = GOT_TLS_GD; break;
2389 	      case R_X86_64_GOTTPOFF: tls_type = GOT_TLS_IE; break;
2390 	      case R_X86_64_GOTPC32_TLSDESC:
2391 	      case R_X86_64_TLSDESC_CALL:
2392 		tls_type = GOT_TLS_GDESC; break;
2393 	      }
2394 
2395 	    if (h != NULL)
2396 	      {
2397 		h->got.refcount += 1;
2398 		old_tls_type = eh->tls_type;
2399 	      }
2400 	    else
2401 	      {
2402 		bfd_signed_vma *local_got_refcounts;
2403 
2404 		/* This is a global offset table entry for a local symbol.  */
2405 		local_got_refcounts = elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd);
2406 		if (local_got_refcounts == NULL)
2407 		  {
2408 		    bfd_size_type size;
2409 
2410 		    size = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
2411 		    size *= sizeof (bfd_signed_vma)
2412 		      + sizeof (bfd_vma) + sizeof (char);
2413 		    local_got_refcounts = ((bfd_signed_vma *)
2414 					   bfd_zalloc (abfd, size));
2415 		    if (local_got_refcounts == NULL)
2416 		      goto error_return;
2417 		    elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd) = local_got_refcounts;
2418 		    elf_x86_64_local_tlsdesc_gotent (abfd)
2419 		      = (bfd_vma *) (local_got_refcounts + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
2420 		    elf_x86_64_local_got_tls_type (abfd)
2421 		      = (char *) (local_got_refcounts + 2 * symtab_hdr->sh_info);
2422 		  }
2423 		local_got_refcounts[r_symndx] += 1;
2424 		old_tls_type
2425 		  = elf_x86_64_local_got_tls_type (abfd) [r_symndx];
2426 	      }
2427 
2428 	    /* If a TLS symbol is accessed using IE at least once,
2429 	       there is no point to use dynamic model for it.  */
2430 	    if (old_tls_type != tls_type && old_tls_type != GOT_UNKNOWN
2431 		&& (! GOT_TLS_GD_ANY_P (old_tls_type)
2432 		    || tls_type != GOT_TLS_IE))
2433 	      {
2434 		if (old_tls_type == GOT_TLS_IE && GOT_TLS_GD_ANY_P (tls_type))
2435 		  tls_type = old_tls_type;
2436 		else if (GOT_TLS_GD_ANY_P (old_tls_type)
2437 			 && GOT_TLS_GD_ANY_P (tls_type))
2438 		  tls_type |= old_tls_type;
2439 		else
2440 		  {
2441 		    if (h)
2442 		      name = h->root.root.string;
2443 		    else
2444 		      name = bfd_elf_sym_name (abfd, symtab_hdr,
2445 					       isym, NULL);
2446 		    (*_bfd_error_handler)
2447 		      (_("%B: '%s' accessed both as normal and thread local symbol"),
2448 		       abfd, name);
2449 		    bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
2450 		    goto error_return;
2451 		  }
2452 	      }
2453 
2454 	    if (old_tls_type != tls_type)
2455 	      {
2456 		if (eh != NULL)
2457 		  eh->tls_type = tls_type;
2458 		else
2459 		  elf_x86_64_local_got_tls_type (abfd) [r_symndx] = tls_type;
2460 	      }
2461 	  }
2462 	  /* Fall through */
2463 
2464 	case R_X86_64_GOTOFF64:
2465 	case R_X86_64_GOTPC32:
2466 	case R_X86_64_GOTPC64:
2467 	create_got:
2468 	  if (eh != NULL)
2469 	    eh->has_got_reloc = 1;
2470 	  if (htab->elf.sgot == NULL)
2471 	    {
2472 	      if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
2473 		htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
2474 	      if (!_bfd_elf_create_got_section (htab->elf.dynobj,
2475 						info))
2476 		goto error_return;
2477 	    }
2478 	  break;
2479 
2480 	case R_X86_64_PLT32:
2481 	case R_X86_64_PLT32_BND:
2482 	  /* This symbol requires a procedure linkage table entry.  We
2483 	     actually build the entry in adjust_dynamic_symbol,
2484 	     because this might be a case of linking PIC code which is
2485 	     never referenced by a dynamic object, in which case we
2486 	     don't need to generate a procedure linkage table entry
2487 	     after all.	 */
2488 
2489 	  /* If this is a local symbol, we resolve it directly without
2490 	     creating a procedure linkage table entry.	*/
2491 	  if (h == NULL)
2492 	    continue;
2493 
2494 	  eh->has_got_reloc = 1;
2495 	  h->needs_plt = 1;
2496 	  h->plt.refcount += 1;
2497 	  break;
2498 
2499 	case R_X86_64_PLTOFF64:
2500 	  /* This tries to form the 'address' of a function relative
2501 	     to GOT.  For global symbols we need a PLT entry.  */
2502 	  if (h != NULL)
2503 	    {
2504 	      h->needs_plt = 1;
2505 	      h->plt.refcount += 1;
2506 	    }
2507 	  goto create_got;
2508 
2509 	case R_X86_64_SIZE32:
2510 	case R_X86_64_SIZE64:
2511 	  size_reloc = TRUE;
2512 	  goto do_size;
2513 
2514 	case R_X86_64_32:
2515 	  if (!ABI_64_P (abfd))
2516 	    goto pointer;
2517 	case R_X86_64_8:
2518 	case R_X86_64_16:
2519 	case R_X86_64_32S:
2520 	  /* Check relocation overflow as these relocs may lead to
2521 	     run-time relocation overflow.  Don't error out for
2522 	     sections we don't care about, such as debug sections or
2523 	     when relocation overflow check is disabled.  */
2524 	  if (!info->no_reloc_overflow_check
2525 	      && (bfd_link_pic (info)
2526 		  || (bfd_link_executable (info)
2527 		      && h != NULL
2528 		      && !h->def_regular
2529 		      && h->def_dynamic
2530 		      && (sec->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)))
2531 	    return elf_x86_64_need_pic (abfd, sec, h, symtab_hdr, isym,
2532 					&x86_64_elf_howto_table[r_type]);
2533 	  /* Fall through.  */
2534 
2535 	case R_X86_64_PC8:
2536 	case R_X86_64_PC16:
2537 	case R_X86_64_PC32:
2538 	case R_X86_64_PC32_BND:
2539 	case R_X86_64_PC64:
2540 	case R_X86_64_64:
2541 pointer:
2542 	  if (eh != NULL && (sec->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
2543 	    eh->has_non_got_reloc = 1;
2544 	  /* We are called after all symbols have been resolved.  Only
2545 	     relocation against STT_GNU_IFUNC symbol must go through
2546 	     PLT.  */
2547 	  if (h != NULL
2548 	      && (bfd_link_executable (info)
2549 		  || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC))
2550 	    {
2551 	      /* If this reloc is in a read-only section, we might
2552 		 need a copy reloc.  We can't check reliably at this
2553 		 stage whether the section is read-only, as input
2554 		 sections have not yet been mapped to output sections.
2555 		 Tentatively set the flag for now, and correct in
2556 		 adjust_dynamic_symbol.  */
2557 	      h->non_got_ref = 1;
2558 
2559 	      /* We may need a .plt entry if the symbol is a function
2560 		 defined in a shared lib or is a STT_GNU_IFUNC function
2561 		 referenced from the code or read-only section.  */
2562 	      if (!h->def_regular
2563 		  || (sec->flags & (SEC_CODE | SEC_READONLY)) != 0)
2564 		h->plt.refcount += 1;
2565 
2566 	      if (r_type == R_X86_64_PC32)
2567 		{
2568 		  /* Since something like ".long foo - ." may be used
2569 		     as pointer, make sure that PLT is used if foo is
2570 		     a function defined in a shared library.  */
2571 		  if ((sec->flags & SEC_CODE) == 0)
2572 		    h->pointer_equality_needed = 1;
2573 		}
2574 	      else if (r_type != R_X86_64_PC32_BND
2575 		       && r_type != R_X86_64_PC64)
2576 		{
2577 		  h->pointer_equality_needed = 1;
2578 		  /* At run-time, R_X86_64_64 can be resolved for both
2579 		     x86-64 and x32. But R_X86_64_32 and R_X86_64_32S
2580 		     can only be resolved for x32.  */
2581 		  if ((sec->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0
2582 		      && (r_type == R_X86_64_64
2583 			  || (!ABI_64_P (abfd)
2584 			      && (r_type == R_X86_64_32
2585 				  || r_type == R_X86_64_32S))))
2586 		    eh->func_pointer_refcount += 1;
2587 		}
2588 	    }
2589 
2590 	  size_reloc = FALSE;
2591 do_size:
2592 	  /* If we are creating a shared library, and this is a reloc
2593 	     against a global symbol, or a non PC relative reloc
2594 	     against a local symbol, then we need to copy the reloc
2595 	     into the shared library.  However, if we are linking with
2596 	     -Bsymbolic, we do not need to copy a reloc against a
2597 	     global symbol which is defined in an object we are
2598 	     including in the link (i.e., DEF_REGULAR is set).	At
2599 	     this point we have not seen all the input files, so it is
2600 	     possible that DEF_REGULAR is not set now but will be set
2601 	     later (it is never cleared).  In case of a weak definition,
2602 	     DEF_REGULAR may be cleared later by a strong definition in
2603 	     a shared library.  We account for that possibility below by
2604 	     storing information in the relocs_copied field of the hash
2605 	     table entry.  A similar situation occurs when creating
2606 	     shared libraries and symbol visibility changes render the
2607 	     symbol local.
2608 
2609 	     If on the other hand, we are creating an executable, we
2610 	     may need to keep relocations for symbols satisfied by a
2611 	     dynamic library if we manage to avoid copy relocs for the
2612 	     symbol.
2613 
2614 	     Generate dynamic pointer relocation against STT_GNU_IFUNC
2615 	     symbol in the non-code section.  */
2616 	  if ((bfd_link_pic (info)
2617 	       && (! IS_X86_64_PCREL_TYPE (r_type)
2618 		   || (h != NULL
2619 		       && (! (bfd_link_pie (info)
2620 			      || SYMBOLIC_BIND (info, h))
2621 			   || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak
2622 			   || !h->def_regular))))
2623 	      || (h != NULL
2624 		  && h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
2625 		  && r_type == htab->pointer_r_type
2626 		  && (sec->flags & SEC_CODE) == 0)
2627 	      || (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
2628 		  && !bfd_link_pic (info)
2629 		  && h != NULL
2630 		  && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak
2631 		      || !h->def_regular)))
2632 	    {
2633 	      struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
2634 	      struct elf_dyn_relocs **head;
2635 
2636 	      /* We must copy these reloc types into the output file.
2637 		 Create a reloc section in dynobj and make room for
2638 		 this reloc.  */
2639 	      if (sreloc == NULL)
2640 		{
2641 		  if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
2642 		    htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
2643 
2644 		  sreloc = _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_reloc_section
2645 		    (sec, htab->elf.dynobj, ABI_64_P (abfd) ? 3 : 2,
2646 		     abfd, /*rela?*/ TRUE);
2647 
2648 		  if (sreloc == NULL)
2649 		    goto error_return;
2650 		}
2651 
2652 	      /* If this is a global symbol, we count the number of
2653 		 relocations we need for this symbol.  */
2654 	      if (h != NULL)
2655 		head = &eh->dyn_relocs;
2656 	      else
2657 		{
2658 		  /* Track dynamic relocs needed for local syms too.
2659 		     We really need local syms available to do this
2660 		     easily.  Oh well.  */
2661 		  asection *s;
2662 		  void **vpp;
2663 
2664 		  isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->sym_cache,
2665 						abfd, r_symndx);
2666 		  if (isym == NULL)
2667 		    goto error_return;
2668 
2669 		  s = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx);
2670 		  if (s == NULL)
2671 		    s = sec;
2672 
2673 		  /* Beware of type punned pointers vs strict aliasing
2674 		     rules.  */
2675 		  vpp = &(elf_section_data (s)->local_dynrel);
2676 		  head = (struct elf_dyn_relocs **)vpp;
2677 		}
2678 
2679 	      p = *head;
2680 	      if (p == NULL || p->sec != sec)
2681 		{
2682 		  bfd_size_type amt = sizeof *p;
2683 
2684 		  p = ((struct elf_dyn_relocs *)
2685 		       bfd_alloc (htab->elf.dynobj, amt));
2686 		  if (p == NULL)
2687 		    goto error_return;
2688 		  p->next = *head;
2689 		  *head = p;
2690 		  p->sec = sec;
2691 		  p->count = 0;
2692 		  p->pc_count = 0;
2693 		}
2694 
2695 	      p->count += 1;
2696 	      /* Count size relocation as PC-relative relocation.  */
2697 	      if (IS_X86_64_PCREL_TYPE (r_type) || size_reloc)
2698 		p->pc_count += 1;
2699 	    }
2700 	  break;
2701 
2702 	  /* This relocation describes the C++ object vtable hierarchy.
2703 	     Reconstruct it for later use during GC.  */
2704 	case R_X86_64_GNU_VTINHERIT:
2705 	  if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtinherit (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_offset))
2706 	    goto error_return;
2707 	  break;
2708 
2709 	  /* This relocation describes which C++ vtable entries are actually
2710 	     used.  Record for later use during GC.  */
2711 	case R_X86_64_GNU_VTENTRY:
2712 	  BFD_ASSERT (h != NULL);
2713 	  if (h != NULL
2714 	      && !bfd_elf_gc_record_vtentry (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_addend))
2715 	    goto error_return;
2716 	  break;
2717 
2718 	default:
2719 	  break;
2720 	}
2721 
2722       if (use_plt_got
2723 	  && h != NULL
2724 	  && h->plt.refcount > 0
2725 	  && (((info->flags & DF_BIND_NOW) && !h->pointer_equality_needed)
2726 	      || h->got.refcount > 0)
2727 	  && htab->plt_got == NULL)
2728 	{
2729 	  /* Create the GOT procedure linkage table.  */
2730 	  unsigned int plt_got_align;
2731 	  const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
2732 
2733 	  bed = get_elf_backend_data (info->output_bfd);
2734 	  BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (elf_x86_64_legacy_plt2_entry) == 8
2735 		      && (sizeof (elf_x86_64_bnd_plt2_entry)
2736 			  == sizeof (elf_x86_64_legacy_plt2_entry)));
2737 	  plt_got_align = 3;
2738 
2739 	  if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
2740 	    htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
2741 	  htab->plt_got
2742 	    = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (htab->elf.dynobj,
2743 						  ".plt.got",
2744 						  (bed->dynamic_sec_flags
2745 						   | SEC_ALLOC
2746 						   | SEC_CODE
2747 						   | SEC_LOAD
2748 						   | SEC_READONLY));
2749 	  if (htab->plt_got == NULL
2750 	      || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->elf.dynobj,
2751 					     htab->plt_got,
2752 					     plt_got_align))
2753 	    goto error_return;
2754 	}
2755 
2756       if ((r_type == R_X86_64_GOTPCREL
2757 	   || r_type == R_X86_64_GOTPCRELX
2758 	   || r_type == R_X86_64_REX_GOTPCRELX)
2759 	  && (h == NULL || h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC))
2760 	sec->need_convert_load = 1;
2761     }
2762 
2763   if (elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
2764     {
2765       if (!info->keep_memory)
2766 	free (contents);
2767       else
2768 	{
2769 	  /* Cache the section contents for elf_link_input_bfd.  */
2770 	  elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents = contents;
2771 	}
2772     }
2773 
2774   return TRUE;
2775 
2776 error_return:
2777   if (elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
2778     free (contents);
2779   sec->check_relocs_failed = 1;
2780   return FALSE;
2781 }
2782 
2783 /* Return the section that should be marked against GC for a given
2784    relocation.	*/
2785 
2786 static asection *
2787 elf_x86_64_gc_mark_hook (asection *sec,
2788 			 struct bfd_link_info *info,
2789 			 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
2790 			 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
2791 			 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
2792 {
2793   if (h != NULL)
2794     switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info))
2795       {
2796       case R_X86_64_GNU_VTINHERIT:
2797       case R_X86_64_GNU_VTENTRY:
2798 	return NULL;
2799       }
2800 
2801   return _bfd_elf_gc_mark_hook (sec, info, rel, h, sym);
2802 }
2803 
2804 /* Remove undefined weak symbol from the dynamic symbol table if it
2805    is resolved to 0.   */
2806 
2807 static bfd_boolean
2808 elf_x86_64_fixup_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
2809 		       struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
2810 {
2811   if (h->dynindx != -1
2812       && UNDEFINED_WEAK_RESOLVED_TO_ZERO (info,
2813 					  elf_x86_64_hash_entry (h)->has_got_reloc,
2814 					  elf_x86_64_hash_entry (h)))
2815     {
2816       h->dynindx = -1;
2817       _bfd_elf_strtab_delref (elf_hash_table (info)->dynstr,
2818 			      h->dynstr_index);
2819     }
2820   return TRUE;
2821 }
2822 
2823 /* Adjust a symbol defined by a dynamic object and referenced by a
2824    regular object.  The current definition is in some section of the
2825    dynamic object, but we're not including those sections.  We have to
2826    change the definition to something the rest of the link can
2827    understand.	*/
2828 
2829 static bfd_boolean
2830 elf_x86_64_adjust_dynamic_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
2831 				  struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
2832 {
2833   struct elf_x86_64_link_hash_table *htab;
2834   asection *s;
2835   struct elf_x86_64_link_hash_entry *eh;
2836   struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
2837 
2838   /* STT_GNU_IFUNC symbol must go through PLT. */
2839   if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
2840     {
2841       /* All local STT_GNU_IFUNC references must be treate as local
2842 	 calls via local PLT.  */
2843       if (h->ref_regular
2844 	  && SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h))
2845 	{
2846 	  bfd_size_type pc_count = 0, count = 0;
2847 	  struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
2848 
2849 	  eh = (struct elf_x86_64_link_hash_entry *) h;
2850 	  for (pp = &eh->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
2851 	    {
2852 	      pc_count += p->pc_count;
2853 	      p->count -= p->pc_count;
2854 	      p->pc_count = 0;
2855 	      count += p->count;
2856 	      if (p->count == 0)
2857 		*pp = p->next;
2858 	      else
2859 		pp = &p->next;
2860 	    }
2861 
2862 	  if (pc_count || count)
2863 	    {
2864 	      h->non_got_ref = 1;
2865 	      if (pc_count)
2866 		{
2867 		  /* Increment PLT reference count only for PC-relative
2868 		     references.  */
2869 		  h->needs_plt = 1;
2870 		  if (h->plt.refcount <= 0)
2871 		    h->plt.refcount = 1;
2872 		  else
2873 		    h->plt.refcount += 1;
2874 		}
2875 	    }
2876 	}
2877 
2878       if (h->plt.refcount <= 0)
2879 	{
2880 	  h->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
2881 	  h->needs_plt = 0;
2882 	}
2883       return TRUE;
2884     }
2885 
2886   /* If this is a function, put it in the procedure linkage table.  We
2887      will fill in the contents of the procedure linkage table later,
2888      when we know the address of the .got section.  */
2889   if (h->type == STT_FUNC
2890       || h->needs_plt)
2891     {
2892       if (h->plt.refcount <= 0
2893 	  || SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
2894 	  || (ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) != STV_DEFAULT
2895 	      && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak))
2896 	{
2897 	  /* This case can occur if we saw a PLT32 reloc in an input
2898 	     file, but the symbol was never referred to by a dynamic
2899 	     object, or if all references were garbage collected.  In
2900 	     such a case, we don't actually need to build a procedure
2901 	     linkage table, and we can just do a PC32 reloc instead.  */
2902 	  h->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
2903 	  h->needs_plt = 0;
2904 	}
2905 
2906       return TRUE;
2907     }
2908   else
2909     /* It's possible that we incorrectly decided a .plt reloc was
2910        needed for an R_X86_64_PC32 reloc to a non-function sym in
2911        check_relocs.  We can't decide accurately between function and
2912        non-function syms in check-relocs;  Objects loaded later in
2913        the link may change h->type.  So fix it now.  */
2914     h->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
2915 
2916   /* If this is a weak symbol, and there is a real definition, the
2917      processor independent code will have arranged for us to see the
2918      real definition first, and we can just use the same value.	 */
2919   if (h->u.weakdef != NULL)
2920     {
2921       BFD_ASSERT (h->u.weakdef->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
2922 		  || h->u.weakdef->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak);
2923       h->root.u.def.section = h->u.weakdef->root.u.def.section;
2924       h->root.u.def.value = h->u.weakdef->root.u.def.value;
2925       if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS || info->nocopyreloc)
2926 	{
2927 	  eh = (struct elf_x86_64_link_hash_entry *) h;
2928 	  h->non_got_ref = h->u.weakdef->non_got_ref;
2929 	  eh->needs_copy = h->u.weakdef->needs_copy;
2930 	}
2931       return TRUE;
2932     }
2933 
2934   /* This is a reference to a symbol defined by a dynamic object which
2935      is not a function.	 */
2936 
2937   /* If we are creating a shared library, we must presume that the
2938      only references to the symbol are via the global offset table.
2939      For such cases we need not do anything here; the relocations will
2940      be handled correctly by relocate_section.	*/
2941   if (!bfd_link_executable (info))
2942     return TRUE;
2943 
2944   /* If there are no references to this symbol that do not use the
2945      GOT, we don't need to generate a copy reloc.  */
2946   if (!h->non_got_ref)
2947     return TRUE;
2948 
2949   /* If -z nocopyreloc was given, we won't generate them either.  */
2950   if (info->nocopyreloc)
2951     {
2952       h->non_got_ref = 0;
2953       return TRUE;
2954     }
2955 
2956   if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS)
2957     {
2958       eh = (struct elf_x86_64_link_hash_entry *) h;
2959       for (p = eh->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
2960 	{
2961 	  s = p->sec->output_section;
2962 	  if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
2963 	    break;
2964 	}
2965 
2966       /* If we didn't find any dynamic relocs in read-only sections, then
2967 	 we'll be keeping the dynamic relocs and avoiding the copy reloc.  */
2968       if (p == NULL)
2969 	{
2970 	  h->non_got_ref = 0;
2971 	  return TRUE;
2972 	}
2973     }
2974 
2975   /* We must allocate the symbol in our .dynbss section, which will
2976      become part of the .bss section of the executable.	 There will be
2977      an entry for this symbol in the .dynsym section.  The dynamic
2978      object will contain position independent code, so all references
2979      from the dynamic object to this symbol will go through the global
2980      offset table.  The dynamic linker will use the .dynsym entry to
2981      determine the address it must put in the global offset table, so
2982      both the dynamic object and the regular object will refer to the
2983      same memory location for the variable.  */
2984 
2985   htab = elf_x86_64_hash_table (info);
2986   if (htab == NULL)
2987     return FALSE;
2988 
2989   /* We must generate a R_X86_64_COPY reloc to tell the dynamic linker
2990      to copy the initial value out of the dynamic object and into the
2991      runtime process image.  */
2992   if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0 && h->size != 0)
2993     {
2994       const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
2995       bed = get_elf_backend_data (info->output_bfd);
2996       htab->srelbss->size += bed->s->sizeof_rela;
2997       h->needs_copy = 1;
2998     }
2999 
3000   s = htab->sdynbss;
3001 
3002   return _bfd_elf_adjust_dynamic_copy (info, h, s);
3003 }
3004 
3005 /* Allocate space in .plt, .got and associated reloc sections for
3006    dynamic relocs.  */
3007 
3008 static bfd_boolean
3009 elf_x86_64_allocate_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void * inf)
3010 {
3011   struct bfd_link_info *info;
3012   struct elf_x86_64_link_hash_table *htab;
3013   struct elf_x86_64_link_hash_entry *eh;
3014   struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
3015   const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
3016   unsigned int plt_entry_size;
3017   bfd_boolean resolved_to_zero;
3018 
3019   if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
3020     return TRUE;
3021 
3022   eh = (struct elf_x86_64_link_hash_entry *) h;
3023 
3024   info = (struct bfd_link_info *) inf;
3025   htab = elf_x86_64_hash_table (info);
3026   if (htab == NULL)
3027     return FALSE;
3028   bed = get_elf_backend_data (info->output_bfd);
3029   plt_entry_size = GET_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE (info->output_bfd);
3030 
3031   resolved_to_zero = UNDEFINED_WEAK_RESOLVED_TO_ZERO (info,
3032 						      eh->has_got_reloc,
3033 						      eh);
3034 
3035   /* We can't use the GOT PLT if pointer equality is needed since
3036      finish_dynamic_symbol won't clear symbol value and the dynamic
3037      linker won't update the GOT slot.  We will get into an infinite
3038      loop at run-time.  */
3039   if (htab->plt_got != NULL
3040       && h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC
3041       && !h->pointer_equality_needed
3042       && h->plt.refcount > 0
3043       && h->got.refcount > 0)
3044     {
3045       /* Don't use the regular PLT if there are both GOT and GOTPLT
3046          reloctions.  */
3047       h->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
3048 
3049       /* Use the GOT PLT.  */
3050       eh->plt_got.refcount = 1;
3051     }
3052 
3053   /* Clear the reference count of function pointer relocations if
3054      symbol isn't a normal function.  */
3055   if (h->type != STT_FUNC)
3056     eh->func_pointer_refcount = 0;
3057 
3058   /* Since STT_GNU_IFUNC symbol must go through PLT, we handle it
3059      here if it is defined and referenced in a non-shared object.  */
3060   if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
3061       && h->def_regular)
3062     {
3063       if (_bfd_elf_allocate_ifunc_dyn_relocs (info, h,
3064 					      &eh->dyn_relocs,
3065 					      &htab->readonly_dynrelocs_against_ifunc,
3066 					      plt_entry_size,
3067 					      plt_entry_size,
3068 					      GOT_ENTRY_SIZE, TRUE))
3069 	{
3070 	  asection *s = htab->plt_bnd;
3071 	  if (h->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1 && s != NULL)
3072 	    {
3073 	      /* Use the .plt.bnd section if it is created.  */
3074 	      eh->plt_bnd.offset = s->size;
3075 
3076 	      /* Make room for this entry in the .plt.bnd section.  */
3077 	      s->size += sizeof (elf_x86_64_legacy_plt2_entry);
3078 	    }
3079 
3080 	  return TRUE;
3081 	}
3082       else
3083 	return FALSE;
3084     }
3085   /* Don't create the PLT entry if there are only function pointer
3086      relocations which can be resolved at run-time.  */
3087   else if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
3088 	   && (h->plt.refcount > eh->func_pointer_refcount
3089 	       || eh->plt_got.refcount > 0))
3090     {
3091       bfd_boolean use_plt_got;
3092 
3093       /* Clear the reference count of function pointer relocations
3094 	 if PLT is used.  */
3095       eh->func_pointer_refcount = 0;
3096 
3097       if ((info->flags & DF_BIND_NOW) && !h->pointer_equality_needed)
3098 	{
3099 	  /* Don't use the regular PLT for DF_BIND_NOW. */
3100 	  h->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
3101 
3102 	  /* Use the GOT PLT.  */
3103 	  h->got.refcount = 1;
3104 	  eh->plt_got.refcount = 1;
3105 	}
3106 
3107       use_plt_got = eh->plt_got.refcount > 0;
3108 
3109       /* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol.
3110 	 Undefined weak syms won't yet be marked as dynamic.  */
3111       if (h->dynindx == -1
3112 	  && !h->forced_local
3113 	  && !resolved_to_zero)
3114 	{
3115 	  if (! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
3116 	    return FALSE;
3117 	}
3118 
3119       if (bfd_link_pic (info)
3120 	  || WILL_CALL_FINISH_DYNAMIC_SYMBOL (1, 0, h))
3121 	{
3122 	  asection *s = htab->elf.splt;
3123 	  asection *bnd_s = htab->plt_bnd;
3124 	  asection *got_s = htab->plt_got;
3125 
3126 	  /* If this is the first .plt entry, make room for the special
3127 	     first entry.  The .plt section is used by prelink to undo
3128 	     prelinking for dynamic relocations.  */
3129 	  if (s->size == 0)
3130 	    s->size = plt_entry_size;
3131 
3132 	  if (use_plt_got)
3133 	    eh->plt_got.offset = got_s->size;
3134 	  else
3135 	    {
3136 	      h->plt.offset = s->size;
3137 	      if (bnd_s)
3138 		eh->plt_bnd.offset = bnd_s->size;
3139 	    }
3140 
3141 	  /* If this symbol is not defined in a regular file, and we are
3142 	     not generating a shared library, then set the symbol to this
3143 	     location in the .plt.  This is required to make function
3144 	     pointers compare as equal between the normal executable and
3145 	     the shared library.  */
3146 	  if (! bfd_link_pic (info)
3147 	      && !h->def_regular)
3148 	    {
3149 	      if (use_plt_got)
3150 		{
3151 		  /* We need to make a call to the entry of the GOT PLT
3152 		     instead of regular PLT entry.  */
3153 		  h->root.u.def.section = got_s;
3154 		  h->root.u.def.value = eh->plt_got.offset;
3155 		}
3156 	      else
3157 		{
3158 		  if (bnd_s)
3159 		    {
3160 		      /* We need to make a call to the entry of the second
3161 			 PLT instead of regular PLT entry.  */
3162 		      h->root.u.def.section = bnd_s;
3163 		      h->root.u.def.value = eh->plt_bnd.offset;
3164 		    }
3165 		  else
3166 		    {
3167 		      h->root.u.def.section = s;
3168 		      h->root.u.def.value = h->plt.offset;
3169 		    }
3170 		}
3171 	    }
3172 
3173 	  /* Make room for this entry.  */
3174 	  if (use_plt_got)
3175 	    got_s->size += sizeof (elf_x86_64_legacy_plt2_entry);
3176 	  else
3177 	    {
3178 	      s->size += plt_entry_size;
3179 	      if (bnd_s)
3180 		bnd_s->size += sizeof (elf_x86_64_legacy_plt2_entry);
3181 
3182 	      /* We also need to make an entry in the .got.plt section,
3183 		 which will be placed in the .got section by the linker
3184 		 script.  */
3185 	      htab->elf.sgotplt->size += GOT_ENTRY_SIZE;
3186 
3187 	      /* There should be no PLT relocation against resolved
3188 		 undefined weak symbol in executable.  */
3189 	      if (!resolved_to_zero)
3190 		{
3191 		  /* We also need to make an entry in the .rela.plt
3192 		     section.  */
3193 		  htab->elf.srelplt->size += bed->s->sizeof_rela;
3194 		  htab->elf.srelplt->reloc_count++;
3195 		}
3196 	    }
3197 	}
3198       else
3199 	{
3200 	  eh->plt_got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
3201 	  h->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
3202 	  h->needs_plt = 0;
3203 	}
3204     }
3205   else
3206     {
3207       eh->plt_got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
3208       h->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
3209       h->needs_plt = 0;
3210     }
3211 
3212   eh->tlsdesc_got = (bfd_vma) -1;
3213 
3214   /* If R_X86_64_GOTTPOFF symbol is now local to the binary,
3215      make it a R_X86_64_TPOFF32 requiring no GOT entry.  */
3216   if (h->got.refcount > 0
3217       && bfd_link_executable (info)
3218       && h->dynindx == -1
3219       && elf_x86_64_hash_entry (h)->tls_type == GOT_TLS_IE)
3220     {
3221       h->got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
3222     }
3223   else if (h->got.refcount > 0)
3224     {
3225       asection *s;
3226       bfd_boolean dyn;
3227       int tls_type = elf_x86_64_hash_entry (h)->tls_type;
3228 
3229       /* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol.
3230 	 Undefined weak syms won't yet be marked as dynamic.  */
3231       if (h->dynindx == -1
3232 	  && !h->forced_local
3233 	  && !resolved_to_zero)
3234 	{
3235 	  if (! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
3236 	    return FALSE;
3237 	}
3238 
3239       if (GOT_TLS_GDESC_P (tls_type))
3240 	{
3241 	  eh->tlsdesc_got = htab->elf.sgotplt->size
3242 	    - elf_x86_64_compute_jump_table_size (htab);
3243 	  htab->elf.sgotplt->size += 2 * GOT_ENTRY_SIZE;
3244 	  h->got.offset = (bfd_vma) -2;
3245 	}
3246       if (! GOT_TLS_GDESC_P (tls_type)
3247 	  || GOT_TLS_GD_P (tls_type))
3248 	{
3249 	  s = htab->elf.sgot;
3250 	  h->got.offset = s->size;
3251 	  s->size += GOT_ENTRY_SIZE;
3252 	  if (GOT_TLS_GD_P (tls_type))
3253 	    s->size += GOT_ENTRY_SIZE;
3254 	}
3255       dyn = htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created;
3256       /* R_X86_64_TLSGD needs one dynamic relocation if local symbol
3257 	 and two if global.  R_X86_64_GOTTPOFF needs one dynamic
3258 	 relocation.  No dynamic relocation against resolved undefined
3259 	 weak symbol in executable.  */
3260       if ((GOT_TLS_GD_P (tls_type) && h->dynindx == -1)
3261 	  || tls_type == GOT_TLS_IE)
3262 	htab->elf.srelgot->size += bed->s->sizeof_rela;
3263       else if (GOT_TLS_GD_P (tls_type))
3264 	htab->elf.srelgot->size += 2 * bed->s->sizeof_rela;
3265       else if (! GOT_TLS_GDESC_P (tls_type)
3266 	       && ((ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) == STV_DEFAULT
3267 		    && !resolved_to_zero)
3268 		   || h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
3269 	       && (bfd_link_pic (info)
3270 		   || WILL_CALL_FINISH_DYNAMIC_SYMBOL (dyn, 0, h)))
3271 	htab->elf.srelgot->size += bed->s->sizeof_rela;
3272       if (GOT_TLS_GDESC_P (tls_type))
3273 	{
3274 	  htab->elf.srelplt->size += bed->s->sizeof_rela;
3275 	  htab->tlsdesc_plt = (bfd_vma) -1;
3276 	}
3277     }
3278   else
3279     h->got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
3280 
3281   if (eh->dyn_relocs == NULL)
3282     return TRUE;
3283 
3284   /* In the shared -Bsymbolic case, discard space allocated for
3285      dynamic pc-relative relocs against symbols which turn out to be
3286      defined in regular objects.  For the normal shared case, discard
3287      space for pc-relative relocs that have become local due to symbol
3288      visibility changes.  */
3289 
3290   if (bfd_link_pic (info))
3291     {
3292       /* Relocs that use pc_count are those that appear on a call
3293 	 insn, or certain REL relocs that can generated via assembly.
3294 	 We want calls to protected symbols to resolve directly to the
3295 	 function rather than going via the plt.  If people want
3296 	 function pointer comparisons to work as expected then they
3297 	 should avoid writing weird assembly.  */
3298       if (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h))
3299 	{
3300 	  struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
3301 
3302 	  for (pp = &eh->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
3303 	    {
3304 	      p->count -= p->pc_count;
3305 	      p->pc_count = 0;
3306 	      if (p->count == 0)
3307 		*pp = p->next;
3308 	      else
3309 		pp = &p->next;
3310 	    }
3311 	}
3312 
3313       /* Also discard relocs on undefined weak syms with non-default
3314 	 visibility or in PIE.  */
3315       if (eh->dyn_relocs != NULL)
3316 	{
3317 	  if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
3318 	    {
3319 	      /* Undefined weak symbol is never bound locally in shared
3320 		 library.  */
3321 	      if (ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) != STV_DEFAULT
3322 		  || resolved_to_zero)
3323 		eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
3324 	      else if (h->dynindx == -1
3325 		       && ! h->forced_local
3326 		       && ! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
3327 		return FALSE;
3328 	    }
3329 	  /* For PIE, discard space for pc-relative relocs against
3330 	     symbols which turn out to need copy relocs.  */
3331 	  else if (bfd_link_executable (info)
3332 		   && (h->needs_copy || eh->needs_copy)
3333 		   && h->def_dynamic
3334 		   && !h->def_regular)
3335 	    {
3336 	      struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
3337 
3338 	      for (pp = &eh->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
3339 		{
3340 		  if (p->pc_count != 0)
3341 		    *pp = p->next;
3342 		  else
3343 		    pp = &p->next;
3344 		}
3345 	    }
3346 	}
3347     }
3348   else if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS)
3349     {
3350       /* For the non-shared case, discard space for relocs against
3351 	 symbols which turn out to need copy relocs or are not
3352 	 dynamic.  Keep dynamic relocations for run-time function
3353 	 pointer initialization.  */
3354 
3355       if ((!h->non_got_ref
3356 	   || eh->func_pointer_refcount > 0
3357 	   || (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
3358 	       && !resolved_to_zero))
3359 	  && ((h->def_dynamic
3360 	       && !h->def_regular)
3361 	      || (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
3362 		  && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
3363 		      || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined))))
3364 	{
3365 	  /* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol.
3366 	     Undefined weak syms won't yet be marked as dynamic.  */
3367 	  if (h->dynindx == -1
3368 	      && ! h->forced_local
3369 	      && ! resolved_to_zero
3370 	      && ! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
3371 	    return FALSE;
3372 
3373 	  /* If that succeeded, we know we'll be keeping all the
3374 	     relocs.  */
3375 	  if (h->dynindx != -1)
3376 	    goto keep;
3377 	}
3378 
3379       eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
3380       eh->func_pointer_refcount = 0;
3381 
3382     keep: ;
3383     }
3384 
3385   /* Finally, allocate space.  */
3386   for (p = eh->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
3387     {
3388       asection * sreloc;
3389 
3390       sreloc = elf_section_data (p->sec)->sreloc;
3391 
3392       BFD_ASSERT (sreloc != NULL);
3393 
3394       sreloc->size += p->count * bed->s->sizeof_rela;
3395     }
3396 
3397   return TRUE;
3398 }
3399 
3400 /* Allocate space in .plt, .got and associated reloc sections for
3401    local dynamic relocs.  */
3402 
3403 static bfd_boolean
3404 elf_x86_64_allocate_local_dynrelocs (void **slot, void *inf)
3405 {
3406   struct elf_link_hash_entry *h
3407     = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) *slot;
3408 
3409   if (h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC
3410       || !h->def_regular
3411       || !h->ref_regular
3412       || !h->forced_local
3413       || h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_defined)
3414     abort ();
3415 
3416   return elf_x86_64_allocate_dynrelocs (h, inf);
3417 }
3418 
3419 /* Find any dynamic relocs that apply to read-only sections.  */
3420 
3421 static bfd_boolean
3422 elf_x86_64_readonly_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
3423 			       void * inf)
3424 {
3425   struct elf_x86_64_link_hash_entry *eh;
3426   struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
3427 
3428   /* Skip local IFUNC symbols. */
3429   if (h->forced_local && h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
3430     return TRUE;
3431 
3432   eh = (struct elf_x86_64_link_hash_entry *) h;
3433   for (p = eh->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
3434     {
3435       asection *s = p->sec->output_section;
3436 
3437       if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
3438 	{
3439 	  struct bfd_link_info *info = (struct bfd_link_info *) inf;
3440 
3441 	  info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
3442 
3443 	  if ((info->warn_shared_textrel && bfd_link_pic (info))
3444 	      || info->error_textrel)
3445 	    info->callbacks->einfo (_("%P: %B: warning: relocation against `%s' in readonly section `%A'\n"),
3446 				    p->sec->owner, h->root.root.string,
3447 				    p->sec);
3448 
3449 	  /* Not an error, just cut short the traversal.  */
3450 	  return FALSE;
3451 	}
3452     }
3453   return TRUE;
3454 }
3455 
3456 /* Convert load via the GOT slot to load immediate.  */
3457 
3458 static bfd_boolean
3459 elf_x86_64_convert_load (bfd *abfd, asection *sec,
3460 			 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
3461 {
3462   Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
3463   Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs;
3464   Elf_Internal_Rela *irel, *irelend;
3465   bfd_byte *contents;
3466   struct elf_x86_64_link_hash_table *htab;
3467   bfd_boolean changed;
3468   bfd_signed_vma *local_got_refcounts;
3469 
3470   /* Don't even try to convert non-ELF outputs.  */
3471   if (!is_elf_hash_table (link_info->hash))
3472     return FALSE;
3473 
3474   /* Nothing to do if there is no need or no output.  */
3475   if ((sec->flags & (SEC_CODE | SEC_RELOC)) != (SEC_CODE | SEC_RELOC)
3476       || sec->need_convert_load == 0
3477       || bfd_is_abs_section (sec->output_section))
3478     return TRUE;
3479 
3480   symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
3481 
3482   /* Load the relocations for this section.  */
3483   internal_relocs = (_bfd_elf_link_read_relocs
3484 		     (abfd, sec, NULL, (Elf_Internal_Rela *) NULL,
3485 		      link_info->keep_memory));
3486   if (internal_relocs == NULL)
3487     return FALSE;
3488 
3489   changed = FALSE;
3490   htab = elf_x86_64_hash_table (link_info);
3491   local_got_refcounts = elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd);
3492 
3493   /* Get the section contents.  */
3494   if (elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents != NULL)
3495     contents = elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents;
3496   else
3497     {
3498       if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, sec, &contents))
3499 	goto error_return;
3500     }
3501 
3502   irelend = internal_relocs + sec->reloc_count;
3503   for (irel = internal_relocs; irel < irelend; irel++)
3504     {
3505       unsigned int r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info);
3506       unsigned int r_symndx;
3507       struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
3508       bfd_boolean converted;
3509 
3510       if (r_type != R_X86_64_GOTPCRELX
3511 	  && r_type != R_X86_64_REX_GOTPCRELX
3512 	  && r_type != R_X86_64_GOTPCREL)
3513 	continue;
3514 
3515       r_symndx = htab->r_sym (irel->r_info);
3516       if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
3517 	h = elf_x86_64_get_local_sym_hash (htab, sec->owner,
3518 					   (const Elf_Internal_Rela *) irel,
3519 					   FALSE);
3520       else
3521 	{
3522 	  h = elf_sym_hashes (abfd)[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
3523 	  while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
3524 		 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
3525 	    h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
3526 	}
3527 
3528       /* STT_GNU_IFUNC must keep GOTPCREL relocations.  */
3529       if (h != NULL && h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
3530 	continue;
3531 
3532       converted = FALSE;
3533       if (!elf_x86_64_convert_load_reloc (abfd, sec, contents, irel, h,
3534 					  &converted, link_info))
3535 	goto error_return;
3536 
3537       if (converted)
3538 	{
3539 	  changed = converted;
3540 	  if (h)
3541 	    {
3542 	      if (h->got.refcount > 0)
3543 		h->got.refcount -= 1;
3544 	    }
3545 	  else
3546 	    {
3547 	      if (local_got_refcounts != NULL
3548 		  && local_got_refcounts[r_symndx] > 0)
3549 		local_got_refcounts[r_symndx] -= 1;
3550 	    }
3551 	}
3552     }
3553 
3554   if (contents != NULL
3555       && elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
3556     {
3557       if (!changed && !link_info->keep_memory)
3558 	free (contents);
3559       else
3560 	{
3561 	  /* Cache the section contents for elf_link_input_bfd.  */
3562 	  elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents = contents;
3563 	}
3564     }
3565 
3566   if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != internal_relocs)
3567     {
3568       if (!changed)
3569 	free (internal_relocs);
3570       else
3571 	elf_section_data (sec)->relocs = internal_relocs;
3572     }
3573 
3574   return TRUE;
3575 
3576  error_return:
3577   if (contents != NULL
3578       && elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
3579     free (contents);
3580   if (internal_relocs != NULL
3581       && elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != internal_relocs)
3582     free (internal_relocs);
3583   return FALSE;
3584 }
3585 
3586 /* Set the sizes of the dynamic sections.  */
3587 
3588 static bfd_boolean
3589 elf_x86_64_size_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
3590 				  struct bfd_link_info *info)
3591 {
3592   struct elf_x86_64_link_hash_table *htab;
3593   bfd *dynobj;
3594   asection *s;
3595   bfd_boolean relocs;
3596   bfd *ibfd;
3597   const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
3598 
3599   htab = elf_x86_64_hash_table (info);
3600   if (htab == NULL)
3601     return FALSE;
3602   bed = get_elf_backend_data (output_bfd);
3603 
3604   dynobj = htab->elf.dynobj;
3605   if (dynobj == NULL)
3606     abort ();
3607 
3608   /* Set up .got offsets for local syms, and space for local dynamic
3609      relocs.  */
3610   for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
3611     {
3612       bfd_signed_vma *local_got;
3613       bfd_signed_vma *end_local_got;
3614       char *local_tls_type;
3615       bfd_vma *local_tlsdesc_gotent;
3616       bfd_size_type locsymcount;
3617       Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
3618       asection *srel;
3619 
3620       if (! is_x86_64_elf (ibfd))
3621 	continue;
3622 
3623       for (s = ibfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
3624 	{
3625 	  struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
3626 
3627 	  if (!elf_x86_64_convert_load (ibfd, s, info))
3628 	    return FALSE;
3629 
3630 	  for (p = (struct elf_dyn_relocs *)
3631 		    (elf_section_data (s)->local_dynrel);
3632 	       p != NULL;
3633 	       p = p->next)
3634 	    {
3635 	      if (!bfd_is_abs_section (p->sec)
3636 		  && bfd_is_abs_section (p->sec->output_section))
3637 		{
3638 		  /* Input section has been discarded, either because
3639 		     it is a copy of a linkonce section or due to
3640 		     linker script /DISCARD/, so we'll be discarding
3641 		     the relocs too.  */
3642 		}
3643 	      else if (p->count != 0)
3644 		{
3645 		  srel = elf_section_data (p->sec)->sreloc;
3646 		  srel->size += p->count * bed->s->sizeof_rela;
3647 		  if ((p->sec->output_section->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0
3648 		      && (info->flags & DF_TEXTREL) == 0)
3649 		    {
3650 		      info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
3651 		      if ((info->warn_shared_textrel && bfd_link_pic (info))
3652 			  || info->error_textrel)
3653 			info->callbacks->einfo (_("%P: %B: warning: relocation in readonly section `%A'\n"),
3654 						p->sec->owner, p->sec);
3655 		    }
3656 		}
3657 	    }
3658 	}
3659 
3660       local_got = elf_local_got_refcounts (ibfd);
3661       if (!local_got)
3662 	continue;
3663 
3664       symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
3665       locsymcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
3666       end_local_got = local_got + locsymcount;
3667       local_tls_type = elf_x86_64_local_got_tls_type (ibfd);
3668       local_tlsdesc_gotent = elf_x86_64_local_tlsdesc_gotent (ibfd);
3669       s = htab->elf.sgot;
3670       srel = htab->elf.srelgot;
3671       for (; local_got < end_local_got;
3672 	   ++local_got, ++local_tls_type, ++local_tlsdesc_gotent)
3673 	{
3674 	  *local_tlsdesc_gotent = (bfd_vma) -1;
3675 	  if (*local_got > 0)
3676 	    {
3677 	      if (GOT_TLS_GDESC_P (*local_tls_type))
3678 		{
3679 		  *local_tlsdesc_gotent = htab->elf.sgotplt->size
3680 		    - elf_x86_64_compute_jump_table_size (htab);
3681 		  htab->elf.sgotplt->size += 2 * GOT_ENTRY_SIZE;
3682 		  *local_got = (bfd_vma) -2;
3683 		}
3684 	      if (! GOT_TLS_GDESC_P (*local_tls_type)
3685 		  || GOT_TLS_GD_P (*local_tls_type))
3686 		{
3687 		  *local_got = s->size;
3688 		  s->size += GOT_ENTRY_SIZE;
3689 		  if (GOT_TLS_GD_P (*local_tls_type))
3690 		    s->size += GOT_ENTRY_SIZE;
3691 		}
3692 	      if (bfd_link_pic (info)
3693 		  || GOT_TLS_GD_ANY_P (*local_tls_type)
3694 		  || *local_tls_type == GOT_TLS_IE)
3695 		{
3696 		  if (GOT_TLS_GDESC_P (*local_tls_type))
3697 		    {
3698 		      htab->elf.srelplt->size
3699 			+= bed->s->sizeof_rela;
3700 		      htab->tlsdesc_plt = (bfd_vma) -1;
3701 		    }
3702 		  if (! GOT_TLS_GDESC_P (*local_tls_type)
3703 		      || GOT_TLS_GD_P (*local_tls_type))
3704 		    srel->size += bed->s->sizeof_rela;
3705 		}
3706 	    }
3707 	  else
3708 	    *local_got = (bfd_vma) -1;
3709 	}
3710     }
3711 
3712   if (htab->tls_ld_got.refcount > 0)
3713     {
3714       /* Allocate 2 got entries and 1 dynamic reloc for R_X86_64_TLSLD
3715 	 relocs.  */
3716       htab->tls_ld_got.offset = htab->elf.sgot->size;
3717       htab->elf.sgot->size += 2 * GOT_ENTRY_SIZE;
3718       htab->elf.srelgot->size += bed->s->sizeof_rela;
3719     }
3720   else
3721     htab->tls_ld_got.offset = -1;
3722 
3723   /* Allocate global sym .plt and .got entries, and space for global
3724      sym dynamic relocs.  */
3725   elf_link_hash_traverse (&htab->elf, elf_x86_64_allocate_dynrelocs,
3726 			  info);
3727 
3728   /* Allocate .plt and .got entries, and space for local symbols.  */
3729   htab_traverse (htab->loc_hash_table,
3730 		 elf_x86_64_allocate_local_dynrelocs,
3731 		 info);
3732 
3733   /* For every jump slot reserved in the sgotplt, reloc_count is
3734      incremented.  However, when we reserve space for TLS descriptors,
3735      it's not incremented, so in order to compute the space reserved
3736      for them, it suffices to multiply the reloc count by the jump
3737      slot size.
3738 
3739      PR ld/13302: We start next_irelative_index at the end of .rela.plt
3740      so that R_X86_64_IRELATIVE entries come last.  */
3741   if (htab->elf.srelplt)
3742     {
3743       htab->sgotplt_jump_table_size
3744 	= elf_x86_64_compute_jump_table_size (htab);
3745       htab->next_irelative_index = htab->elf.srelplt->reloc_count - 1;
3746     }
3747   else if (htab->elf.irelplt)
3748     htab->next_irelative_index = htab->elf.irelplt->reloc_count - 1;
3749 
3750   if (htab->tlsdesc_plt)
3751     {
3752       /* If we're not using lazy TLS relocations, don't generate the
3753 	 PLT and GOT entries they require.  */
3754       if ((info->flags & DF_BIND_NOW))
3755 	htab->tlsdesc_plt = 0;
3756       else
3757 	{
3758 	  htab->tlsdesc_got = htab->elf.sgot->size;
3759 	  htab->elf.sgot->size += GOT_ENTRY_SIZE;
3760 	  /* Reserve room for the initial entry.
3761 	     FIXME: we could probably do away with it in this case.  */
3762 	  if (htab->elf.splt->size == 0)
3763 	    htab->elf.splt->size += GET_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE (output_bfd);
3764 	  htab->tlsdesc_plt = htab->elf.splt->size;
3765 	  htab->elf.splt->size += GET_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE (output_bfd);
3766 	}
3767     }
3768 
3769   if (htab->elf.sgotplt)
3770     {
3771       /* Don't allocate .got.plt section if there are no GOT nor PLT
3772 	 entries and there is no refeence to _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_.  */
3773       if ((htab->elf.hgot == NULL
3774 	   || !htab->elf.hgot->ref_regular_nonweak)
3775 	  && (htab->elf.sgotplt->size
3776 	      == get_elf_backend_data (output_bfd)->got_header_size)
3777 	  && (htab->elf.splt == NULL
3778 	      || htab->elf.splt->size == 0)
3779 	  && (htab->elf.sgot == NULL
3780 	      || htab->elf.sgot->size == 0)
3781 	  && (htab->elf.iplt == NULL
3782 	      || htab->elf.iplt->size == 0)
3783 	  && (htab->elf.igotplt == NULL
3784 	      || htab->elf.igotplt->size == 0))
3785 	htab->elf.sgotplt->size = 0;
3786     }
3787 
3788   if (htab->plt_eh_frame != NULL
3789       && htab->elf.splt != NULL
3790       && htab->elf.splt->size != 0
3791       && !bfd_is_abs_section (htab->elf.splt->output_section)
3792       && _bfd_elf_eh_frame_present (info))
3793     {
3794       const struct elf_x86_64_backend_data *arch_data
3795 	= get_elf_x86_64_arch_data (bed);
3796       htab->plt_eh_frame->size = arch_data->eh_frame_plt_size;
3797     }
3798 
3799   /* We now have determined the sizes of the various dynamic sections.
3800      Allocate memory for them.  */
3801   relocs = FALSE;
3802   for (s = dynobj->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
3803     {
3804       if ((s->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) == 0)
3805 	continue;
3806 
3807       if (s == htab->elf.splt
3808 	  || s == htab->elf.sgot
3809 	  || s == htab->elf.sgotplt
3810 	  || s == htab->elf.iplt
3811 	  || s == htab->elf.igotplt
3812 	  || s == htab->plt_bnd
3813 	  || s == htab->plt_got
3814 	  || s == htab->plt_eh_frame
3815 	  || s == htab->sdynbss)
3816 	{
3817 	  /* Strip this section if we don't need it; see the
3818 	     comment below.  */
3819 	}
3820       else if (CONST_STRNEQ (bfd_get_section_name (dynobj, s), ".rela"))
3821 	{
3822 	  if (s->size != 0 && s != htab->elf.srelplt)
3823 	    relocs = TRUE;
3824 
3825 	  /* We use the reloc_count field as a counter if we need
3826 	     to copy relocs into the output file.  */
3827 	  if (s != htab->elf.srelplt)
3828 	    s->reloc_count = 0;
3829 	}
3830       else
3831 	{
3832 	  /* It's not one of our sections, so don't allocate space.  */
3833 	  continue;
3834 	}
3835 
3836       if (s->size == 0)
3837 	{
3838 	  /* If we don't need this section, strip it from the
3839 	     output file.  This is mostly to handle .rela.bss and
3840 	     .rela.plt.  We must create both sections in
3841 	     create_dynamic_sections, because they must be created
3842 	     before the linker maps input sections to output
3843 	     sections.  The linker does that before
3844 	     adjust_dynamic_symbol is called, and it is that
3845 	     function which decides whether anything needs to go
3846 	     into these sections.  */
3847 
3848 	  s->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
3849 	  continue;
3850 	}
3851 
3852       if ((s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) == 0)
3853 	continue;
3854 
3855       /* Allocate memory for the section contents.  We use bfd_zalloc
3856 	 here in case unused entries are not reclaimed before the
3857 	 section's contents are written out.  This should not happen,
3858 	 but this way if it does, we get a R_X86_64_NONE reloc instead
3859 	 of garbage.  */
3860       s->contents = (bfd_byte *) bfd_zalloc (dynobj, s->size);
3861       if (s->contents == NULL)
3862 	return FALSE;
3863     }
3864 
3865   if (htab->plt_eh_frame != NULL
3866       && htab->plt_eh_frame->contents != NULL)
3867     {
3868       const struct elf_x86_64_backend_data *arch_data
3869 	= get_elf_x86_64_arch_data (bed);
3870 
3871       memcpy (htab->plt_eh_frame->contents,
3872 	      arch_data->eh_frame_plt, htab->plt_eh_frame->size);
3873       bfd_put_32 (dynobj, htab->elf.splt->size,
3874 		  htab->plt_eh_frame->contents + PLT_FDE_LEN_OFFSET);
3875     }
3876 
3877   if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
3878     {
3879       /* Add some entries to the .dynamic section.  We fill in the
3880 	 values later, in elf_x86_64_finish_dynamic_sections, but we
3881 	 must add the entries now so that we get the correct size for
3882 	 the .dynamic section.	The DT_DEBUG entry is filled in by the
3883 	 dynamic linker and used by the debugger.  */
3884 #define add_dynamic_entry(TAG, VAL) \
3885   _bfd_elf_add_dynamic_entry (info, TAG, VAL)
3886 
3887       if (bfd_link_executable (info))
3888 	{
3889 	  if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_DEBUG, 0))
3890 	    return FALSE;
3891 	}
3892 
3893       if (htab->elf.splt->size != 0)
3894 	{
3895 	  /* DT_PLTGOT is used by prelink even if there is no PLT
3896 	     relocation.  */
3897 	  if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_PLTGOT, 0))
3898 	    return FALSE;
3899 
3900 	  if (htab->elf.srelplt->size != 0)
3901 	    {
3902 	      if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_PLTRELSZ, 0)
3903 		  || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PLTREL, DT_RELA)
3904 		  || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_JMPREL, 0))
3905 		return FALSE;
3906 	    }
3907 
3908 	  if (htab->tlsdesc_plt
3909 	      && (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_TLSDESC_PLT, 0)
3910 		  || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_TLSDESC_GOT, 0)))
3911 	    return FALSE;
3912 	}
3913 
3914       if (relocs)
3915 	{
3916 	  if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_RELA, 0)
3917 	      || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_RELASZ, 0)
3918 	      || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_RELAENT, bed->s->sizeof_rela))
3919 	    return FALSE;
3920 
3921 	  /* If any dynamic relocs apply to a read-only section,
3922 	     then we need a DT_TEXTREL entry.  */
3923 	  if ((info->flags & DF_TEXTREL) == 0)
3924 	    elf_link_hash_traverse (&htab->elf,
3925 				    elf_x86_64_readonly_dynrelocs,
3926 				    info);
3927 
3928 	  if ((info->flags & DF_TEXTREL) != 0)
3929 	    {
3930 	      if (htab->readonly_dynrelocs_against_ifunc)
3931 		{
3932 		  info->callbacks->einfo
3933 		    (_("%P%X: read-only segment has dynamic IFUNC relocations; recompile with -fPIC\n"));
3934 		  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3935 		  return FALSE;
3936 		}
3937 
3938 	      if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_TEXTREL, 0))
3939 		return FALSE;
3940 	    }
3941 	}
3942     }
3943 #undef add_dynamic_entry
3944 
3945   return TRUE;
3946 }
3947 
3948 static bfd_boolean
3949 elf_x86_64_always_size_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
3950 				 struct bfd_link_info *info)
3951 {
3952   asection *tls_sec = elf_hash_table (info)->tls_sec;
3953 
3954   if (tls_sec)
3955     {
3956       struct elf_link_hash_entry *tlsbase;
3957 
3958       tlsbase = elf_link_hash_lookup (elf_hash_table (info),
3959 				      "_TLS_MODULE_BASE_",
3960 				      FALSE, FALSE, FALSE);
3961 
3962       if (tlsbase && tlsbase->type == STT_TLS)
3963 	{
3964 	  struct elf_x86_64_link_hash_table *htab;
3965 	  struct bfd_link_hash_entry *bh = NULL;
3966 	  const struct elf_backend_data *bed
3967 	    = get_elf_backend_data (output_bfd);
3968 
3969 	  htab = elf_x86_64_hash_table (info);
3970 	  if (htab == NULL)
3971 	    return FALSE;
3972 
3973 	  if (!(_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
3974 		(info, output_bfd, "_TLS_MODULE_BASE_", BSF_LOCAL,
3975 		 tls_sec, 0, NULL, FALSE,
3976 		 bed->collect, &bh)))
3977 	    return FALSE;
3978 
3979 	  htab->tls_module_base = bh;
3980 
3981 	  tlsbase = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *)bh;
3982 	  tlsbase->def_regular = 1;
3983 	  tlsbase->other = STV_HIDDEN;
3984 	  tlsbase->root.linker_def = 1;
3985 	  (*bed->elf_backend_hide_symbol) (info, tlsbase, TRUE);
3986 	}
3987     }
3988 
3989   return TRUE;
3990 }
3991 
3992 /* _TLS_MODULE_BASE_ needs to be treated especially when linking
3993    executables.  Rather than setting it to the beginning of the TLS
3994    section, we have to set it to the end.  This function may be called
3995    multiple times, it is idempotent.  */
3996 
3997 static void
3998 elf_x86_64_set_tls_module_base (struct bfd_link_info *info)
3999 {
4000   struct elf_x86_64_link_hash_table *htab;
4001   struct bfd_link_hash_entry *base;
4002 
4003   if (!bfd_link_executable (info))
4004     return;
4005 
4006   htab = elf_x86_64_hash_table (info);
4007   if (htab == NULL)
4008     return;
4009 
4010   base = htab->tls_module_base;
4011   if (base == NULL)
4012     return;
4013 
4014   base->u.def.value = htab->elf.tls_size;
4015 }
4016 
4017 /* Return the base VMA address which should be subtracted from real addresses
4018    when resolving @dtpoff relocation.
4019    This is PT_TLS segment p_vaddr.  */
4020 
4021 static bfd_vma
4022 elf_x86_64_dtpoff_base (struct bfd_link_info *info)
4023 {
4024   /* If tls_sec is NULL, we should have signalled an error already.  */
4025   if (elf_hash_table (info)->tls_sec == NULL)
4026     return 0;
4027   return elf_hash_table (info)->tls_sec->vma;
4028 }
4029 
4030 /* Return the relocation value for @tpoff relocation
4031    if STT_TLS virtual address is ADDRESS.  */
4032 
4033 static bfd_vma
4034 elf_x86_64_tpoff (struct bfd_link_info *info, bfd_vma address)
4035 {
4036   struct elf_link_hash_table *htab = elf_hash_table (info);
4037   const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (info->output_bfd);
4038   bfd_vma static_tls_size;
4039 
4040   /* If tls_segment is NULL, we should have signalled an error already.  */
4041   if (htab->tls_sec == NULL)
4042     return 0;
4043 
4044   /* Consider special static TLS alignment requirements.  */
4045   static_tls_size = BFD_ALIGN (htab->tls_size, bed->static_tls_alignment);
4046   return address - static_tls_size - htab->tls_sec->vma;
4047 }
4048 
4049 /* Is the instruction before OFFSET in CONTENTS a 32bit relative
4050    branch?  */
4051 
4052 static bfd_boolean
4053 is_32bit_relative_branch (bfd_byte *contents, bfd_vma offset)
4054 {
4055   /* Opcode		Instruction
4056      0xe8		call
4057      0xe9		jump
4058      0x0f 0x8x		conditional jump */
4059   return ((offset > 0
4060 	   && (contents [offset - 1] == 0xe8
4061 	       || contents [offset - 1] == 0xe9))
4062 	  || (offset > 1
4063 	      && contents [offset - 2] == 0x0f
4064 	      && (contents [offset - 1] & 0xf0) == 0x80));
4065 }
4066 
4067 /* Relocate an x86_64 ELF section.  */
4068 
4069 static bfd_boolean
4070 elf_x86_64_relocate_section (bfd *output_bfd,
4071 			     struct bfd_link_info *info,
4072 			     bfd *input_bfd,
4073 			     asection *input_section,
4074 			     bfd_byte *contents,
4075 			     Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs,
4076 			     Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms,
4077 			     asection **local_sections)
4078 {
4079   struct elf_x86_64_link_hash_table *htab;
4080   Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
4081   struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
4082   bfd_vma *local_got_offsets;
4083   bfd_vma *local_tlsdesc_gotents;
4084   Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
4085   Elf_Internal_Rela *wrel;
4086   Elf_Internal_Rela *relend;
4087   const unsigned int plt_entry_size = GET_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE (info->output_bfd);
4088 
4089   BFD_ASSERT (is_x86_64_elf (input_bfd));
4090 
4091   /* Skip if check_relocs failed.  */
4092   if (input_section->check_relocs_failed)
4093     return FALSE;
4094 
4095   htab = elf_x86_64_hash_table (info);
4096   if (htab == NULL)
4097     return FALSE;
4098   symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (input_bfd);
4099   sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd);
4100   local_got_offsets = elf_local_got_offsets (input_bfd);
4101   local_tlsdesc_gotents = elf_x86_64_local_tlsdesc_gotent (input_bfd);
4102 
4103   elf_x86_64_set_tls_module_base (info);
4104 
4105   rel = wrel = relocs;
4106   relend = relocs + input_section->reloc_count;
4107   for (; rel < relend; wrel++, rel++)
4108     {
4109       unsigned int r_type;
4110       reloc_howto_type *howto;
4111       unsigned long r_symndx;
4112       struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
4113       struct elf_x86_64_link_hash_entry *eh;
4114       Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
4115       asection *sec;
4116       bfd_vma off, offplt, plt_offset;
4117       bfd_vma relocation;
4118       bfd_boolean unresolved_reloc;
4119       bfd_reloc_status_type r;
4120       int tls_type;
4121       asection *base_got, *resolved_plt;
4122       bfd_vma st_size;
4123       bfd_boolean resolved_to_zero;
4124 
4125       r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
4126       if (r_type == (int) R_X86_64_GNU_VTINHERIT
4127 	  || r_type == (int) R_X86_64_GNU_VTENTRY)
4128 	{
4129 	  if (wrel != rel)
4130 	    *wrel = *rel;
4131 	  continue;
4132 	}
4133 
4134       if (r_type >= (int) R_X86_64_standard)
4135 	{
4136 	  (*_bfd_error_handler)
4137 	    (_("%B: unrecognized relocation (0x%x) in section `%A'"),
4138 	     input_bfd, input_section, r_type);
4139 	  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
4140 	  return FALSE;
4141 	}
4142 
4143       if (r_type != (int) R_X86_64_32
4144 	  || ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
4145 	howto = x86_64_elf_howto_table + r_type;
4146       else
4147 	howto = (x86_64_elf_howto_table
4148 		 + ARRAY_SIZE (x86_64_elf_howto_table) - 1);
4149       r_symndx = htab->r_sym (rel->r_info);
4150       h = NULL;
4151       sym = NULL;
4152       sec = NULL;
4153       unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
4154       if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
4155 	{
4156 	  sym = local_syms + r_symndx;
4157 	  sec = local_sections[r_symndx];
4158 
4159 	  relocation = _bfd_elf_rela_local_sym (output_bfd, sym,
4160 						&sec, rel);
4161 	  st_size = sym->st_size;
4162 
4163 	  /* Relocate against local STT_GNU_IFUNC symbol.  */
4164 	  if (!bfd_link_relocatable (info)
4165 	      && ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
4166 	    {
4167 	      h = elf_x86_64_get_local_sym_hash (htab, input_bfd,
4168 						 rel, FALSE);
4169 	      if (h == NULL)
4170 		abort ();
4171 
4172 	      /* Set STT_GNU_IFUNC symbol value.  */
4173 	      h->root.u.def.value = sym->st_value;
4174 	      h->root.u.def.section = sec;
4175 	    }
4176 	}
4177       else
4178 	{
4179 	  bfd_boolean warned ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
4180 	  bfd_boolean ignored ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
4181 
4182 	  RELOC_FOR_GLOBAL_SYMBOL (info, input_bfd, input_section, rel,
4183 				   r_symndx, symtab_hdr, sym_hashes,
4184 				   h, sec, relocation,
4185 				   unresolved_reloc, warned, ignored);
4186 	  st_size = h->size;
4187 	}
4188 
4189       if (sec != NULL && discarded_section (sec))
4190 	{
4191 	  _bfd_clear_contents (howto, input_bfd, input_section,
4192 			       contents + rel->r_offset);
4193 	  wrel->r_offset = rel->r_offset;
4194 	  wrel->r_info = 0;
4195 	  wrel->r_addend = 0;
4196 
4197 	  /* For ld -r, remove relocations in debug sections against
4198 	     sections defined in discarded sections.  Not done for
4199 	     eh_frame editing code expects to be present.  */
4200 	   if (bfd_link_relocatable (info)
4201 	       && (input_section->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING))
4202 	     wrel--;
4203 
4204 	  continue;
4205 	}
4206 
4207       if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
4208 	{
4209 	  if (wrel != rel)
4210 	    *wrel = *rel;
4211 	  continue;
4212 	}
4213 
4214       if (rel->r_addend == 0 && !ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
4215 	{
4216 	  if (r_type == R_X86_64_64)
4217 	    {
4218 	      /* For x32, treat R_X86_64_64 like R_X86_64_32 and
4219 		 zero-extend it to 64bit if addend is zero.  */
4220 	      r_type = R_X86_64_32;
4221 	      memset (contents + rel->r_offset + 4, 0, 4);
4222 	    }
4223 	  else if (r_type == R_X86_64_SIZE64)
4224 	    {
4225 	      /* For x32, treat R_X86_64_SIZE64 like R_X86_64_SIZE32 and
4226 		 zero-extend it to 64bit if addend is zero.  */
4227 	      r_type = R_X86_64_SIZE32;
4228 	      memset (contents + rel->r_offset + 4, 0, 4);
4229 	    }
4230 	}
4231 
4232       eh = (struct elf_x86_64_link_hash_entry *) h;
4233 
4234       /* Since STT_GNU_IFUNC symbol must go through PLT, we handle
4235 	 it here if it is defined in a non-shared object.  */
4236       if (h != NULL
4237 	  && h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
4238 	  && h->def_regular)
4239 	{
4240 	  bfd_vma plt_index;
4241 	  const char *name;
4242 
4243 	  if ((input_section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0)
4244 	    {
4245 	      /* Dynamic relocs are not propagated for SEC_DEBUGGING
4246 		 sections because such sections are not SEC_ALLOC and
4247 		 thus ld.so will not process them.  */
4248 	      if ((input_section->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING) != 0)
4249 		continue;
4250 	      abort ();
4251 	    }
4252 
4253 	  switch (r_type)
4254 	    {
4255 	    default:
4256 	      break;
4257 
4258 	    case R_X86_64_GOTPCREL:
4259 	    case R_X86_64_GOTPCRELX:
4260 	    case R_X86_64_REX_GOTPCRELX:
4261 	    case R_X86_64_GOTPCREL64:
4262 	      base_got = htab->elf.sgot;
4263 	      off = h->got.offset;
4264 
4265 	      if (base_got == NULL)
4266 		abort ();
4267 
4268 	      if (off == (bfd_vma) -1)
4269 		{
4270 		  /* We can't use h->got.offset here to save state, or
4271 		     even just remember the offset, as finish_dynamic_symbol
4272 		     would use that as offset into .got.  */
4273 
4274 		  if (h->plt.offset == (bfd_vma) -1)
4275 		    abort ();
4276 
4277 		  if (htab->elf.splt != NULL)
4278 		    {
4279 		      plt_index = h->plt.offset / plt_entry_size - 1;
4280 		      off = (plt_index + 3) * GOT_ENTRY_SIZE;
4281 		      base_got = htab->elf.sgotplt;
4282 		    }
4283 		  else
4284 		    {
4285 		      plt_index = h->plt.offset / plt_entry_size;
4286 		      off = plt_index * GOT_ENTRY_SIZE;
4287 		      base_got = htab->elf.igotplt;
4288 		    }
4289 
4290 		  if (h->dynindx == -1
4291 		      || h->forced_local
4292 		      || info->symbolic)
4293 		    {
4294 		      /* This references the local defitionion.  We must
4295 			 initialize this entry in the global offset table.
4296 			 Since the offset must always be a multiple of 8,
4297 			 we use the least significant bit to record
4298 			 whether we have initialized it already.
4299 
4300 			 When doing a dynamic link, we create a .rela.got
4301 			 relocation entry to initialize the value.  This
4302 			 is done in the finish_dynamic_symbol routine.	 */
4303 		      if ((off & 1) != 0)
4304 			off &= ~1;
4305 		      else
4306 			{
4307 			  bfd_put_64 (output_bfd, relocation,
4308 				      base_got->contents + off);
4309 			  /* Note that this is harmless for the GOTPLT64
4310 			     case, as -1 | 1 still is -1.  */
4311 			  h->got.offset |= 1;
4312 			}
4313 		    }
4314 		}
4315 
4316 	      relocation = (base_got->output_section->vma
4317 			    + base_got->output_offset + off);
4318 
4319 	      goto do_relocation;
4320 	    }
4321 
4322 	  if (h->plt.offset == (bfd_vma) -1)
4323 	    {
4324 	      /* Handle static pointers of STT_GNU_IFUNC symbols.  */
4325 	      if (r_type == htab->pointer_r_type
4326 		  && (input_section->flags & SEC_CODE) == 0)
4327 		goto do_ifunc_pointer;
4328 	      goto bad_ifunc_reloc;
4329 	    }
4330 
4331 	  /* STT_GNU_IFUNC symbol must go through PLT.  */
4332 	  if (htab->elf.splt != NULL)
4333 	    {
4334 	      if (htab->plt_bnd != NULL)
4335 		{
4336 		  resolved_plt = htab->plt_bnd;
4337 		  plt_offset = eh->plt_bnd.offset;
4338 		}
4339 	      else
4340 		{
4341 		  resolved_plt = htab->elf.splt;
4342 		  plt_offset =  h->plt.offset;
4343 		}
4344 	    }
4345 	  else
4346 	    {
4347 	      resolved_plt = htab->elf.iplt;
4348 	      plt_offset =  h->plt.offset;
4349 	    }
4350 
4351 	  relocation = (resolved_plt->output_section->vma
4352 			+ resolved_plt->output_offset + plt_offset);
4353 
4354 	  switch (r_type)
4355 	    {
4356 	    default:
4357 bad_ifunc_reloc:
4358 	      if (h->root.root.string)
4359 		name = h->root.root.string;
4360 	      else
4361 		name = bfd_elf_sym_name (input_bfd, symtab_hdr, sym,
4362 					 NULL);
4363 	      (*_bfd_error_handler)
4364 		(_("%B: relocation %s against STT_GNU_IFUNC "
4365 		   "symbol `%s' isn't supported"), input_bfd,
4366 		 howto->name, name);
4367 	      bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
4368 	      return FALSE;
4369 
4370 	    case R_X86_64_32S:
4371 	      if (bfd_link_pic (info))
4372 		abort ();
4373 	      goto do_relocation;
4374 
4375 	    case R_X86_64_32:
4376 	      if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
4377 		goto do_relocation;
4378 	      /* FALLTHROUGH */
4379 	    case R_X86_64_64:
4380 do_ifunc_pointer:
4381 	      if (rel->r_addend != 0)
4382 		{
4383 		  if (h->root.root.string)
4384 		    name = h->root.root.string;
4385 		  else
4386 		    name = bfd_elf_sym_name (input_bfd, symtab_hdr,
4387 					     sym, NULL);
4388 		  (*_bfd_error_handler)
4389 		    (_("%B: relocation %s against STT_GNU_IFUNC "
4390 		       "symbol `%s' has non-zero addend: %d"),
4391 		     input_bfd, howto->name, name, rel->r_addend);
4392 		  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
4393 		  return FALSE;
4394 		}
4395 
4396 	      /* Generate dynamic relcoation only when there is a
4397 		 non-GOT reference in a shared object or there is no
4398 		 PLT.  */
4399 	      if ((bfd_link_pic (info) && h->non_got_ref)
4400 		  || h->plt.offset == (bfd_vma) -1)
4401 		{
4402 		  Elf_Internal_Rela outrel;
4403 		  asection *sreloc;
4404 
4405 		  /* Need a dynamic relocation to get the real function
4406 		     address.  */
4407 		  outrel.r_offset = _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd,
4408 							     info,
4409 							     input_section,
4410 							     rel->r_offset);
4411 		  if (outrel.r_offset == (bfd_vma) -1
4412 		      || outrel.r_offset == (bfd_vma) -2)
4413 		    abort ();
4414 
4415 		  outrel.r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma
4416 				      + input_section->output_offset);
4417 
4418 		  if (h->dynindx == -1
4419 		      || h->forced_local
4420 		      || bfd_link_executable (info))
4421 		    {
4422 		      /* This symbol is resolved locally.  */
4423 		      outrel.r_info = htab->r_info (0, R_X86_64_IRELATIVE);
4424 		      outrel.r_addend = (h->root.u.def.value
4425 					 + h->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma
4426 					 + h->root.u.def.section->output_offset);
4427 		    }
4428 		  else
4429 		    {
4430 		      outrel.r_info = htab->r_info (h->dynindx, r_type);
4431 		      outrel.r_addend = 0;
4432 		    }
4433 
4434 		  /* Dynamic relocations are stored in
4435 		     1. .rela.ifunc section in PIC object.
4436 		     2. .rela.got section in dynamic executable.
4437 		     3. .rela.iplt section in static executable.  */
4438 		  if (bfd_link_pic (info))
4439 		    sreloc = htab->elf.irelifunc;
4440 		  else if (htab->elf.splt != NULL)
4441 		    sreloc = htab->elf.srelgot;
4442 		  else
4443 		    sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
4444 		  elf_append_rela (output_bfd, sreloc, &outrel);
4445 
4446 		  /* If this reloc is against an external symbol, we
4447 		     do not want to fiddle with the addend.  Otherwise,
4448 		     we need to include the symbol value so that it
4449 		     becomes an addend for the dynamic reloc.  For an
4450 		     internal symbol, we have updated addend.  */
4451 		  continue;
4452 		}
4453 	      /* FALLTHROUGH */
4454 	    case R_X86_64_PC32:
4455 	    case R_X86_64_PC32_BND:
4456 	    case R_X86_64_PC64:
4457 	    case R_X86_64_PLT32:
4458 	    case R_X86_64_PLT32_BND:
4459 	      goto do_relocation;
4460 	    }
4461 	}
4462 
4463       resolved_to_zero = (eh != NULL
4464 			  && UNDEFINED_WEAK_RESOLVED_TO_ZERO (info,
4465 							      eh->has_got_reloc,
4466 							      eh));
4467 
4468       /* When generating a shared object, the relocations handled here are
4469 	 copied into the output file to be resolved at run time.  */
4470       switch (r_type)
4471 	{
4472 	case R_X86_64_GOT32:
4473 	case R_X86_64_GOT64:
4474 	  /* Relocation is to the entry for this symbol in the global
4475 	     offset table.  */
4476 	case R_X86_64_GOTPCREL:
4477 	case R_X86_64_GOTPCRELX:
4478 	case R_X86_64_REX_GOTPCRELX:
4479 	case R_X86_64_GOTPCREL64:
4480 	  /* Use global offset table entry as symbol value.  */
4481 	case R_X86_64_GOTPLT64:
4482 	  /* This is obsolete and treated the the same as GOT64.  */
4483 	  base_got = htab->elf.sgot;
4484 
4485 	  if (htab->elf.sgot == NULL)
4486 	    abort ();
4487 
4488 	  if (h != NULL)
4489 	    {
4490 	      bfd_boolean dyn;
4491 
4492 	      off = h->got.offset;
4493 	      if (h->needs_plt
4494 		  && h->plt.offset != (bfd_vma)-1
4495 		  && off == (bfd_vma)-1)
4496 		{
4497 		  /* We can't use h->got.offset here to save
4498 		     state, or even just remember the offset, as
4499 		     finish_dynamic_symbol would use that as offset into
4500 		     .got.  */
4501 		  bfd_vma plt_index = h->plt.offset / plt_entry_size - 1;
4502 		  off = (plt_index + 3) * GOT_ENTRY_SIZE;
4503 		  base_got = htab->elf.sgotplt;
4504 		}
4505 
4506 	      dyn = htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created;
4507 
4508 	      if (! WILL_CALL_FINISH_DYNAMIC_SYMBOL (dyn, bfd_link_pic (info), h)
4509 		  || (bfd_link_pic (info)
4510 		      && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
4511 		  || (ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other)
4512 		      && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak))
4513 		{
4514 		  /* This is actually a static link, or it is a -Bsymbolic
4515 		     link and the symbol is defined locally, or the symbol
4516 		     was forced to be local because of a version file.	We
4517 		     must initialize this entry in the global offset table.
4518 		     Since the offset must always be a multiple of 8, we
4519 		     use the least significant bit to record whether we
4520 		     have initialized it already.
4521 
4522 		     When doing a dynamic link, we create a .rela.got
4523 		     relocation entry to initialize the value.	This is
4524 		     done in the finish_dynamic_symbol routine.	 */
4525 		  if ((off & 1) != 0)
4526 		    off &= ~1;
4527 		  else
4528 		    {
4529 		      bfd_put_64 (output_bfd, relocation,
4530 				  base_got->contents + off);
4531 		      /* Note that this is harmless for the GOTPLT64 case,
4532 			 as -1 | 1 still is -1.  */
4533 		      h->got.offset |= 1;
4534 		    }
4535 		}
4536 	      else
4537 		unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
4538 	    }
4539 	  else
4540 	    {
4541 	      if (local_got_offsets == NULL)
4542 		abort ();
4543 
4544 	      off = local_got_offsets[r_symndx];
4545 
4546 	      /* The offset must always be a multiple of 8.  We use
4547 		 the least significant bit to record whether we have
4548 		 already generated the necessary reloc.	 */
4549 	      if ((off & 1) != 0)
4550 		off &= ~1;
4551 	      else
4552 		{
4553 		  bfd_put_64 (output_bfd, relocation,
4554 			      base_got->contents + off);
4555 
4556 		  if (bfd_link_pic (info))
4557 		    {
4558 		      asection *s;
4559 		      Elf_Internal_Rela outrel;
4560 
4561 		      /* We need to generate a R_X86_64_RELATIVE reloc
4562 			 for the dynamic linker.  */
4563 		      s = htab->elf.srelgot;
4564 		      if (s == NULL)
4565 			abort ();
4566 
4567 		      outrel.r_offset = (base_got->output_section->vma
4568 					 + base_got->output_offset
4569 					 + off);
4570 		      outrel.r_info = htab->r_info (0, R_X86_64_RELATIVE);
4571 		      outrel.r_addend = relocation;
4572 		      elf_append_rela (output_bfd, s, &outrel);
4573 		    }
4574 
4575 		  local_got_offsets[r_symndx] |= 1;
4576 		}
4577 	    }
4578 
4579 	  if (off >= (bfd_vma) -2)
4580 	    abort ();
4581 
4582 	  relocation = base_got->output_section->vma
4583 		       + base_got->output_offset + off;
4584 	  if (r_type != R_X86_64_GOTPCREL
4585 	      && r_type != R_X86_64_GOTPCRELX
4586 	      && r_type != R_X86_64_REX_GOTPCRELX
4587 	      && r_type != R_X86_64_GOTPCREL64)
4588 	    relocation -= htab->elf.sgotplt->output_section->vma
4589 			  - htab->elf.sgotplt->output_offset;
4590 
4591 	  break;
4592 
4593 	case R_X86_64_GOTOFF64:
4594 	  /* Relocation is relative to the start of the global offset
4595 	     table.  */
4596 
4597 	  /* Check to make sure it isn't a protected function or data
4598 	     symbol for shared library since it may not be local when
4599 	     used as function address or with copy relocation.  We also
4600 	     need to make sure that a symbol is referenced locally.  */
4601 	  if (bfd_link_pic (info) && h)
4602 	    {
4603 	      if (!h->def_regular)
4604 		{
4605 		  const char *v;
4606 
4607 		  switch (ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other))
4608 		    {
4609 		    case STV_HIDDEN:
4610 		      v = _("hidden symbol");
4611 		      break;
4612 		    case STV_INTERNAL:
4613 		      v = _("internal symbol");
4614 		      break;
4615 		    case STV_PROTECTED:
4616 		      v = _("protected symbol");
4617 		      break;
4618 		    default:
4619 		      v = _("symbol");
4620 		      break;
4621 		    }
4622 
4623 		  (*_bfd_error_handler)
4624 		    (_("%B: relocation R_X86_64_GOTOFF64 against undefined %s `%s' can not be used when making a shared object"),
4625 		     input_bfd, v, h->root.root.string);
4626 		  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
4627 		  return FALSE;
4628 		}
4629 	      else if (!bfd_link_executable (info)
4630 		       && !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h)
4631 		       && (h->type == STT_FUNC
4632 			   || h->type == STT_OBJECT)
4633 		       && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) == STV_PROTECTED)
4634 		{
4635 		  (*_bfd_error_handler)
4636 		    (_("%B: relocation R_X86_64_GOTOFF64 against protected %s `%s' can not be used when making a shared object"),
4637 		     input_bfd,
4638 		     h->type == STT_FUNC ? "function" : "data",
4639 		     h->root.root.string);
4640 		  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
4641 	      return FALSE;
4642 		}
4643 	    }
4644 
4645 	  /* Note that sgot is not involved in this
4646 	     calculation.  We always want the start of .got.plt.  If we
4647 	     defined _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ in a different way, as is
4648 	     permitted by the ABI, we might have to change this
4649 	     calculation.  */
4650 	  relocation -= htab->elf.sgotplt->output_section->vma
4651 			+ htab->elf.sgotplt->output_offset;
4652 	  break;
4653 
4654 	case R_X86_64_GOTPC32:
4655 	case R_X86_64_GOTPC64:
4656 	  /* Use global offset table as symbol value.  */
4657 	  relocation = htab->elf.sgotplt->output_section->vma
4658 		       + htab->elf.sgotplt->output_offset;
4659 	  unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
4660 	  break;
4661 
4662 	case R_X86_64_PLTOFF64:
4663 	  /* Relocation is PLT entry relative to GOT.  For local
4664 	     symbols it's the symbol itself relative to GOT.  */
4665 	  if (h != NULL
4666 	      /* See PLT32 handling.  */
4667 	      && h->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1
4668 	      && htab->elf.splt != NULL)
4669 	    {
4670 	      if (htab->plt_bnd != NULL)
4671 		{
4672 		  resolved_plt = htab->plt_bnd;
4673 		  plt_offset = eh->plt_bnd.offset;
4674 		}
4675 	      else
4676 		{
4677 		  resolved_plt = htab->elf.splt;
4678 		  plt_offset = h->plt.offset;
4679 		}
4680 
4681 	      relocation = (resolved_plt->output_section->vma
4682 			    + resolved_plt->output_offset
4683 			    + plt_offset);
4684 	      unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
4685 	    }
4686 
4687 	  relocation -= htab->elf.sgotplt->output_section->vma
4688 			+ htab->elf.sgotplt->output_offset;
4689 	  break;
4690 
4691 	case R_X86_64_PLT32:
4692 	case R_X86_64_PLT32_BND:
4693 	  /* Relocation is to the entry for this symbol in the
4694 	     procedure linkage table.  */
4695 
4696 	  /* Resolve a PLT32 reloc against a local symbol directly,
4697 	     without using the procedure linkage table.	 */
4698 	  if (h == NULL)
4699 	    break;
4700 
4701 	  if ((h->plt.offset == (bfd_vma) -1
4702 	       && eh->plt_got.offset == (bfd_vma) -1)
4703 	      || htab->elf.splt == NULL)
4704 	    {
4705 	      /* We didn't make a PLT entry for this symbol.  This
4706 		 happens when statically linking PIC code, or when
4707 		 using -Bsymbolic.  */
4708 	      break;
4709 	    }
4710 
4711 	  if (h->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
4712 	    {
4713 	      if (htab->plt_bnd != NULL)
4714 		{
4715 		  resolved_plt = htab->plt_bnd;
4716 		  plt_offset = eh->plt_bnd.offset;
4717 		}
4718 	      else
4719 		{
4720 		  resolved_plt = htab->elf.splt;
4721 		  plt_offset = h->plt.offset;
4722 		}
4723 	    }
4724 	  else
4725 	    {
4726 	      /* Use the GOT PLT.  */
4727 	      resolved_plt = htab->plt_got;
4728 	      plt_offset = eh->plt_got.offset;
4729 	    }
4730 
4731 	  relocation = (resolved_plt->output_section->vma
4732 			+ resolved_plt->output_offset
4733 			+ plt_offset);
4734 	  unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
4735 	  break;
4736 
4737 	case R_X86_64_SIZE32:
4738 	case R_X86_64_SIZE64:
4739 	  /* Set to symbol size.  */
4740 	  relocation = st_size;
4741 	  goto direct;
4742 
4743 	case R_X86_64_PC8:
4744 	case R_X86_64_PC16:
4745 	case R_X86_64_PC32:
4746 	case R_X86_64_PC32_BND:
4747 	  /* Don't complain about -fPIC if the symbol is undefined when
4748 	     building executable unless it is unresolved weak symbol.  */
4749           if ((input_section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
4750 	      && (input_section->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0
4751 	      && h != NULL
4752 	      && ((bfd_link_executable (info)
4753 		  && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
4754 		  && !resolved_to_zero)
4755 		  || (bfd_link_pic (info)
4756 		      && !(bfd_link_pie (info)
4757 			   && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined))))
4758 	    {
4759 	      bfd_boolean fail = FALSE;
4760 	      bfd_boolean branch
4761 		= ((r_type == R_X86_64_PC32
4762 		    || r_type == R_X86_64_PC32_BND)
4763 		   && is_32bit_relative_branch (contents, rel->r_offset));
4764 
4765 	      if (SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
4766 		{
4767 		  /* Symbol is referenced locally.  Make sure it is
4768 		     defined locally or for a branch.  */
4769 		  fail = !h->def_regular && !branch;
4770 		}
4771 	      else if (!(bfd_link_pie (info)
4772 			 && (h->needs_copy || eh->needs_copy)))
4773 		{
4774 		  /* Symbol doesn't need copy reloc and isn't referenced
4775 		     locally.  We only allow branch to symbol with
4776 		     non-default visibility. */
4777 		  fail = (!branch
4778 			  || ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) == STV_DEFAULT);
4779 		}
4780 
4781 	      if (fail)
4782 		return elf_x86_64_need_pic (input_bfd, input_section,
4783 					    h, NULL, NULL, howto);
4784 	    }
4785 	  /* Fall through.  */
4786 
4787 	case R_X86_64_8:
4788 	case R_X86_64_16:
4789 	case R_X86_64_32:
4790 	case R_X86_64_PC64:
4791 	case R_X86_64_64:
4792 	  /* FIXME: The ABI says the linker should make sure the value is
4793 	     the same when it's zeroextended to 64 bit.	 */
4794 
4795 direct:
4796 	  if ((input_section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0)
4797 	    break;
4798 
4799 	   /* Don't copy a pc-relative relocation into the output file
4800 	      if the symbol needs copy reloc or the symbol is undefined
4801 	      when building executable.  Copy dynamic function pointer
4802 	      relocations.  Don't generate dynamic relocations against
4803 	      resolved undefined weak symbols in PIE.  */
4804 	  if ((bfd_link_pic (info)
4805 	       && !(bfd_link_pie (info)
4806 		    && h != NULL
4807 		    && (h->needs_copy
4808 			|| eh->needs_copy
4809 			|| h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined)
4810 		    && IS_X86_64_PCREL_TYPE (r_type))
4811 	       && (h == NULL
4812 		   || ((ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) == STV_DEFAULT
4813 			&& !resolved_to_zero)
4814 		       || h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak))
4815 	       && ((! IS_X86_64_PCREL_TYPE (r_type)
4816 		      && r_type != R_X86_64_SIZE32
4817 		      && r_type != R_X86_64_SIZE64)
4818 		   || ! SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)))
4819 	      || (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
4820 		  && !bfd_link_pic (info)
4821 		  && h != NULL
4822 		  && h->dynindx != -1
4823 		  && (!h->non_got_ref
4824 		      || eh->func_pointer_refcount > 0
4825 		      || (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
4826 			  && !resolved_to_zero))
4827 		  && ((h->def_dynamic && !h->def_regular)
4828 		      /* Undefined weak symbol is bound locally when
4829 			 PIC is false.  */
4830 		      || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined)))
4831 	    {
4832 	      Elf_Internal_Rela outrel;
4833 	      bfd_boolean skip, relocate;
4834 	      asection *sreloc;
4835 
4836 	      /* When generating a shared object, these relocations
4837 		 are copied into the output file to be resolved at run
4838 		 time.	*/
4839 	      skip = FALSE;
4840 	      relocate = FALSE;
4841 
4842 	      outrel.r_offset =
4843 		_bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section,
4844 					 rel->r_offset);
4845 	      if (outrel.r_offset == (bfd_vma) -1)
4846 		skip = TRUE;
4847 	      else if (outrel.r_offset == (bfd_vma) -2)
4848 		skip = TRUE, relocate = TRUE;
4849 
4850 	      outrel.r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma
4851 				  + input_section->output_offset);
4852 
4853 	      if (skip)
4854 		memset (&outrel, 0, sizeof outrel);
4855 
4856 	      /* h->dynindx may be -1 if this symbol was marked to
4857 		 become local.  */
4858 	      else if (h != NULL
4859 		       && h->dynindx != -1
4860 		       && (IS_X86_64_PCREL_TYPE (r_type)
4861 			   || !(bfd_link_executable (info)
4862 				|| SYMBOLIC_BIND (info, h))
4863 			   || ! h->def_regular))
4864 		{
4865 		  outrel.r_info = htab->r_info (h->dynindx, r_type);
4866 		  outrel.r_addend = rel->r_addend;
4867 		}
4868 	      else
4869 		{
4870 		  /* This symbol is local, or marked to become local.
4871 		     When relocation overflow check is disabled, we
4872 		     convert R_X86_64_32 to dynamic R_X86_64_RELATIVE.  */
4873 		  if (r_type == htab->pointer_r_type
4874 		      || (r_type == R_X86_64_32
4875 			  && info->no_reloc_overflow_check))
4876 		    {
4877 		      relocate = TRUE;
4878 		      outrel.r_info = htab->r_info (0, R_X86_64_RELATIVE);
4879 		      outrel.r_addend = relocation + rel->r_addend;
4880 		    }
4881 		  else if (r_type == R_X86_64_64
4882 			   && !ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
4883 		    {
4884 		      relocate = TRUE;
4885 		      outrel.r_info = htab->r_info (0,
4886 						    R_X86_64_RELATIVE64);
4887 		      outrel.r_addend = relocation + rel->r_addend;
4888 		      /* Check addend overflow.  */
4889 		      if ((outrel.r_addend & 0x80000000)
4890 			  != (rel->r_addend & 0x80000000))
4891 			{
4892 			  const char *name;
4893 			  int addend = rel->r_addend;
4894 			  if (h && h->root.root.string)
4895 			    name = h->root.root.string;
4896 			  else
4897 			    name = bfd_elf_sym_name (input_bfd, symtab_hdr,
4898 						     sym, NULL);
4899 			  if (addend < 0)
4900 			    (*_bfd_error_handler)
4901 			      (_("%B: addend -0x%x in relocation %s against "
4902 				 "symbol `%s' at 0x%lx in section `%A' is "
4903 				 "out of range"),
4904 			       input_bfd, input_section, addend,
4905 			       howto->name, name,
4906 			       (unsigned long) rel->r_offset);
4907 			  else
4908 			    (*_bfd_error_handler)
4909 			      (_("%B: addend 0x%x in relocation %s against "
4910 				 "symbol `%s' at 0x%lx in section `%A' is "
4911 				 "out of range"),
4912 			       input_bfd, input_section, addend,
4913 			       howto->name, name,
4914 			       (unsigned long) rel->r_offset);
4915 			  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
4916 			  return FALSE;
4917 			}
4918 		    }
4919 		  else
4920 		    {
4921 		      long sindx;
4922 
4923 		      if (bfd_is_abs_section (sec))
4924 			sindx = 0;
4925 		      else if (sec == NULL || sec->owner == NULL)
4926 			{
4927 			  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
4928 			  return FALSE;
4929 			}
4930 		      else
4931 			{
4932 			  asection *osec;
4933 
4934 			  /* We are turning this relocation into one
4935 			     against a section symbol.  It would be
4936 			     proper to subtract the symbol's value,
4937 			     osec->vma, from the emitted reloc addend,
4938 			     but ld.so expects buggy relocs.  */
4939 			  osec = sec->output_section;
4940 			  sindx = elf_section_data (osec)->dynindx;
4941 			  if (sindx == 0)
4942 			    {
4943 			      asection *oi = htab->elf.text_index_section;
4944 			      sindx = elf_section_data (oi)->dynindx;
4945 			    }
4946 			  BFD_ASSERT (sindx != 0);
4947 			}
4948 
4949 		      outrel.r_info = htab->r_info (sindx, r_type);
4950 		      outrel.r_addend = relocation + rel->r_addend;
4951 		    }
4952 		}
4953 
4954 	      sreloc = elf_section_data (input_section)->sreloc;
4955 
4956 	      if (sreloc == NULL || sreloc->contents == NULL)
4957 		{
4958 		  r = bfd_reloc_notsupported;
4959 		  goto check_relocation_error;
4960 		}
4961 
4962 	      elf_append_rela (output_bfd, sreloc, &outrel);
4963 
4964 	      /* If this reloc is against an external symbol, we do
4965 		 not want to fiddle with the addend.  Otherwise, we
4966 		 need to include the symbol value so that it becomes
4967 		 an addend for the dynamic reloc.  */
4968 	      if (! relocate)
4969 		continue;
4970 	    }
4971 
4972 	  break;
4973 
4974 	case R_X86_64_TLSGD:
4975 	case R_X86_64_GOTPC32_TLSDESC:
4976 	case R_X86_64_TLSDESC_CALL:
4977 	case R_X86_64_GOTTPOFF:
4978 	  tls_type = GOT_UNKNOWN;
4979 	  if (h == NULL && local_got_offsets)
4980 	    tls_type = elf_x86_64_local_got_tls_type (input_bfd) [r_symndx];
4981 	  else if (h != NULL)
4982 	    tls_type = elf_x86_64_hash_entry (h)->tls_type;
4983 
4984 	  if (! elf_x86_64_tls_transition (info, input_bfd,
4985 					   input_section, contents,
4986 					   symtab_hdr, sym_hashes,
4987 					   &r_type, tls_type, rel,
4988 					   relend, h, r_symndx, TRUE))
4989 	    return FALSE;
4990 
4991 	  if (r_type == R_X86_64_TPOFF32)
4992 	    {
4993 	      bfd_vma roff = rel->r_offset;
4994 
4995 	      BFD_ASSERT (! unresolved_reloc);
4996 
4997 	      if (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info) == R_X86_64_TLSGD)
4998 		{
4999 		  /* GD->LE transition.  For 64bit, change
5000 			.byte 0x66; leaq foo@tlsgd(%rip), %rdi
5001 			.word 0x6666; rex64; call __tls_get_addr@PLT
5002 		     or
5003 			.byte 0x66; leaq foo@tlsgd(%rip), %rdi
5004 			.byte 0x66; rex64
5005 			call *__tls_get_addr@GOTPCREL(%rip)
5006 			which may be converted to
5007 			addr32 call __tls_get_addr
5008 		     into:
5009 			movq %fs:0, %rax
5010 			leaq foo@tpoff(%rax), %rax
5011 		     For 32bit, change
5012 			leaq foo@tlsgd(%rip), %rdi
5013 			.word 0x6666; rex64; call __tls_get_addr@PLT
5014 		     or
5015 			leaq foo@tlsgd(%rip), %rdi
5016 			.byte 0x66; rex64
5017 			call *__tls_get_addr@GOTPCREL(%rip)
5018 			which may be converted to
5019 			addr32 call __tls_get_addr
5020 		     into:
5021 			movl %fs:0, %eax
5022 			leaq foo@tpoff(%rax), %rax
5023 		     For largepic, change:
5024 			leaq foo@tlsgd(%rip), %rdi
5025 			movabsq $__tls_get_addr@pltoff, %rax
5026 			addq %r15, %rax
5027 			call *%rax
5028 		     into:
5029 			movq %fs:0, %rax
5030 			leaq foo@tpoff(%rax), %rax
5031 			nopw 0x0(%rax,%rax,1)  */
5032 		  int largepic = 0;
5033 		  if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
5034 		    {
5035 		      if (contents[roff + 5] == 0xb8)
5036 			{
5037 			  memcpy (contents + roff - 3,
5038 				  "\x64\x48\x8b\x04\x25\0\0\0\0\x48\x8d\x80"
5039 				  "\0\0\0\0\x66\x0f\x1f\x44\0", 22);
5040 			  largepic = 1;
5041 			}
5042 		      else
5043 			memcpy (contents + roff - 4,
5044 				"\x64\x48\x8b\x04\x25\0\0\0\0\x48\x8d\x80\0\0\0",
5045 				16);
5046 		    }
5047 		  else
5048 		    memcpy (contents + roff - 3,
5049 			    "\x64\x8b\x04\x25\0\0\0\0\x48\x8d\x80\0\0\0",
5050 			    15);
5051 		  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd,
5052 			      elf_x86_64_tpoff (info, relocation),
5053 			      contents + roff + 8 + largepic);
5054 		  /* Skip R_X86_64_PC32, R_X86_64_PLT32,
5055 		     R_X86_64_GOTPCRELX and R_X86_64_PLTOFF64.  */
5056 		  rel++;
5057 		  wrel++;
5058 		  continue;
5059 		}
5060 	      else if (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info) == R_X86_64_GOTPC32_TLSDESC)
5061 		{
5062 		  /* GDesc -> LE transition.
5063 		     It's originally something like:
5064 		     leaq x@tlsdesc(%rip), %rax
5065 
5066 		     Change it to:
5067 		     movl $x@tpoff, %rax.  */
5068 
5069 		  unsigned int val, type;
5070 
5071 		  type = bfd_get_8 (input_bfd, contents + roff - 3);
5072 		  val = bfd_get_8 (input_bfd, contents + roff - 1);
5073 		  bfd_put_8 (output_bfd, 0x48 | ((type >> 2) & 1),
5074 			     contents + roff - 3);
5075 		  bfd_put_8 (output_bfd, 0xc7, contents + roff - 2);
5076 		  bfd_put_8 (output_bfd, 0xc0 | ((val >> 3) & 7),
5077 			     contents + roff - 1);
5078 		  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd,
5079 			      elf_x86_64_tpoff (info, relocation),
5080 			      contents + roff);
5081 		  continue;
5082 		}
5083 	      else if (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info) == R_X86_64_TLSDESC_CALL)
5084 		{
5085 		  /* GDesc -> LE transition.
5086 		     It's originally:
5087 		     call *(%rax)
5088 		     Turn it into:
5089 		     xchg %ax,%ax.  */
5090 		  bfd_put_8 (output_bfd, 0x66, contents + roff);
5091 		  bfd_put_8 (output_bfd, 0x90, contents + roff + 1);
5092 		  continue;
5093 		}
5094 	      else if (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info) == R_X86_64_GOTTPOFF)
5095 		{
5096 		  /* IE->LE transition:
5097 		     For 64bit, originally it can be one of:
5098 		     movq foo@gottpoff(%rip), %reg
5099 		     addq foo@gottpoff(%rip), %reg
5100 		     We change it into:
5101 		     movq $foo, %reg
5102 		     leaq foo(%reg), %reg
5103 		     addq $foo, %reg.
5104 		     For 32bit, originally it can be one of:
5105 		     movq foo@gottpoff(%rip), %reg
5106 		     addl foo@gottpoff(%rip), %reg
5107 		     We change it into:
5108 		     movq $foo, %reg
5109 		     leal foo(%reg), %reg
5110 		     addl $foo, %reg. */
5111 
5112 		  unsigned int val, type, reg;
5113 
5114 		  if (roff >= 3)
5115 		    val = bfd_get_8 (input_bfd, contents + roff - 3);
5116 		  else
5117 		    val = 0;
5118 		  type = bfd_get_8 (input_bfd, contents + roff - 2);
5119 		  reg = bfd_get_8 (input_bfd, contents + roff - 1);
5120 		  reg >>= 3;
5121 		  if (type == 0x8b)
5122 		    {
5123 		      /* movq */
5124 		      if (val == 0x4c)
5125 			bfd_put_8 (output_bfd, 0x49,
5126 				   contents + roff - 3);
5127 		      else if (!ABI_64_P (output_bfd) && val == 0x44)
5128 			bfd_put_8 (output_bfd, 0x41,
5129 				   contents + roff - 3);
5130 		      bfd_put_8 (output_bfd, 0xc7,
5131 				 contents + roff - 2);
5132 		      bfd_put_8 (output_bfd, 0xc0 | reg,
5133 				 contents + roff - 1);
5134 		    }
5135 		  else if (reg == 4)
5136 		    {
5137 		      /* addq/addl -> addq/addl - addressing with %rsp/%r12
5138 			 is special  */
5139 		      if (val == 0x4c)
5140 			bfd_put_8 (output_bfd, 0x49,
5141 				   contents + roff - 3);
5142 		      else if (!ABI_64_P (output_bfd) && val == 0x44)
5143 			bfd_put_8 (output_bfd, 0x41,
5144 				   contents + roff - 3);
5145 		      bfd_put_8 (output_bfd, 0x81,
5146 				 contents + roff - 2);
5147 		      bfd_put_8 (output_bfd, 0xc0 | reg,
5148 				 contents + roff - 1);
5149 		    }
5150 		  else
5151 		    {
5152 		      /* addq/addl -> leaq/leal */
5153 		      if (val == 0x4c)
5154 			bfd_put_8 (output_bfd, 0x4d,
5155 				   contents + roff - 3);
5156 		      else if (!ABI_64_P (output_bfd) && val == 0x44)
5157 			bfd_put_8 (output_bfd, 0x45,
5158 				   contents + roff - 3);
5159 		      bfd_put_8 (output_bfd, 0x8d,
5160 				 contents + roff - 2);
5161 		      bfd_put_8 (output_bfd, 0x80 | reg | (reg << 3),
5162 				 contents + roff - 1);
5163 		    }
5164 		  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd,
5165 			      elf_x86_64_tpoff (info, relocation),
5166 			      contents + roff);
5167 		  continue;
5168 		}
5169 	      else
5170 		BFD_ASSERT (FALSE);
5171 	    }
5172 
5173 	  if (htab->elf.sgot == NULL)
5174 	    abort ();
5175 
5176 	  if (h != NULL)
5177 	    {
5178 	      off = h->got.offset;
5179 	      offplt = elf_x86_64_hash_entry (h)->tlsdesc_got;
5180 	    }
5181 	  else
5182 	    {
5183 	      if (local_got_offsets == NULL)
5184 		abort ();
5185 
5186 	      off = local_got_offsets[r_symndx];
5187 	      offplt = local_tlsdesc_gotents[r_symndx];
5188 	    }
5189 
5190 	  if ((off & 1) != 0)
5191 	    off &= ~1;
5192 	  else
5193 	    {
5194 	      Elf_Internal_Rela outrel;
5195 	      int dr_type, indx;
5196 	      asection *sreloc;
5197 
5198 	      if (htab->elf.srelgot == NULL)
5199 		abort ();
5200 
5201 	      indx = h && h->dynindx != -1 ? h->dynindx : 0;
5202 
5203 	      if (GOT_TLS_GDESC_P (tls_type))
5204 		{
5205 		  outrel.r_info = htab->r_info (indx, R_X86_64_TLSDESC);
5206 		  BFD_ASSERT (htab->sgotplt_jump_table_size + offplt
5207 			      + 2 * GOT_ENTRY_SIZE <= htab->elf.sgotplt->size);
5208 		  outrel.r_offset = (htab->elf.sgotplt->output_section->vma
5209 				     + htab->elf.sgotplt->output_offset
5210 				     + offplt
5211 				     + htab->sgotplt_jump_table_size);
5212 		  sreloc = htab->elf.srelplt;
5213 		  if (indx == 0)
5214 		    outrel.r_addend = relocation - elf_x86_64_dtpoff_base (info);
5215 		  else
5216 		    outrel.r_addend = 0;
5217 		  elf_append_rela (output_bfd, sreloc, &outrel);
5218 		}
5219 
5220 	      sreloc = htab->elf.srelgot;
5221 
5222 	      outrel.r_offset = (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
5223 				 + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset + off);
5224 
5225 	      if (GOT_TLS_GD_P (tls_type))
5226 		dr_type = R_X86_64_DTPMOD64;
5227 	      else if (GOT_TLS_GDESC_P (tls_type))
5228 		goto dr_done;
5229 	      else
5230 		dr_type = R_X86_64_TPOFF64;
5231 
5232 	      bfd_put_64 (output_bfd, 0, htab->elf.sgot->contents + off);
5233 	      outrel.r_addend = 0;
5234 	      if ((dr_type == R_X86_64_TPOFF64
5235 		   || dr_type == R_X86_64_TLSDESC) && indx == 0)
5236 		outrel.r_addend = relocation - elf_x86_64_dtpoff_base (info);
5237 	      outrel.r_info = htab->r_info (indx, dr_type);
5238 
5239 	      elf_append_rela (output_bfd, sreloc, &outrel);
5240 
5241 	      if (GOT_TLS_GD_P (tls_type))
5242 		{
5243 		  if (indx == 0)
5244 		    {
5245 		      BFD_ASSERT (! unresolved_reloc);
5246 		      bfd_put_64 (output_bfd,
5247 				  relocation - elf_x86_64_dtpoff_base (info),
5248 				  htab->elf.sgot->contents + off + GOT_ENTRY_SIZE);
5249 		    }
5250 		  else
5251 		    {
5252 		      bfd_put_64 (output_bfd, 0,
5253 				  htab->elf.sgot->contents + off + GOT_ENTRY_SIZE);
5254 		      outrel.r_info = htab->r_info (indx,
5255 						    R_X86_64_DTPOFF64);
5256 		      outrel.r_offset += GOT_ENTRY_SIZE;
5257 		      elf_append_rela (output_bfd, sreloc,
5258 						&outrel);
5259 		    }
5260 		}
5261 
5262 	    dr_done:
5263 	      if (h != NULL)
5264 		h->got.offset |= 1;
5265 	      else
5266 		local_got_offsets[r_symndx] |= 1;
5267 	    }
5268 
5269 	  if (off >= (bfd_vma) -2
5270 	      && ! GOT_TLS_GDESC_P (tls_type))
5271 	    abort ();
5272 	  if (r_type == ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info))
5273 	    {
5274 	      if (r_type == R_X86_64_GOTPC32_TLSDESC
5275 		  || r_type == R_X86_64_TLSDESC_CALL)
5276 		relocation = htab->elf.sgotplt->output_section->vma
5277 		  + htab->elf.sgotplt->output_offset
5278 		  + offplt + htab->sgotplt_jump_table_size;
5279 	      else
5280 		relocation = htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
5281 		  + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset + off;
5282 	      unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
5283 	    }
5284 	  else
5285 	    {
5286 	      bfd_vma roff = rel->r_offset;
5287 
5288 	      if (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info) == R_X86_64_TLSGD)
5289 		{
5290 		  /* GD->IE transition.  For 64bit, change
5291 			.byte 0x66; leaq foo@tlsgd(%rip), %rdi
5292 			.word 0x6666; rex64; call __tls_get_addr@PLT
5293 		     or
5294 			.byte 0x66; leaq foo@tlsgd(%rip), %rdi
5295 			.byte 0x66; rex64
5296 			call *__tls_get_addr@GOTPCREL(%rip
5297 			which may be converted to
5298 			addr32 call __tls_get_addr
5299 		     into:
5300 			movq %fs:0, %rax
5301 			addq foo@gottpoff(%rip), %rax
5302 		     For 32bit, change
5303 			leaq foo@tlsgd(%rip), %rdi
5304 			.word 0x6666; rex64; call __tls_get_addr@PLT
5305 		     or
5306 			leaq foo@tlsgd(%rip), %rdi
5307 			.byte 0x66; rex64;
5308 			call *__tls_get_addr@GOTPCREL(%rip)
5309 			which may be converted to
5310 			addr32 call __tls_get_addr
5311 		     into:
5312 			movl %fs:0, %eax
5313 			addq foo@gottpoff(%rip), %rax
5314 		     For largepic, change:
5315 			leaq foo@tlsgd(%rip), %rdi
5316 			movabsq $__tls_get_addr@pltoff, %rax
5317 			addq %r15, %rax
5318 			call *%rax
5319 		     into:
5320 			movq %fs:0, %rax
5321 			addq foo@gottpoff(%rax), %rax
5322 			nopw 0x0(%rax,%rax,1)  */
5323 		  int largepic = 0;
5324 		  if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
5325 		    {
5326 		      if (contents[roff + 5] == 0xb8)
5327 			{
5328 			  memcpy (contents + roff - 3,
5329 				  "\x64\x48\x8b\x04\x25\0\0\0\0\x48\x03\x05"
5330 				  "\0\0\0\0\x66\x0f\x1f\x44\0", 22);
5331 			  largepic = 1;
5332 			}
5333 		      else
5334 			memcpy (contents + roff - 4,
5335 				"\x64\x48\x8b\x04\x25\0\0\0\0\x48\x03\x05\0\0\0",
5336 				16);
5337 		    }
5338 		  else
5339 		    memcpy (contents + roff - 3,
5340 			    "\x64\x8b\x04\x25\0\0\0\0\x48\x03\x05\0\0\0",
5341 			    15);
5342 
5343 		  relocation = (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
5344 				+ htab->elf.sgot->output_offset + off
5345 				- roff
5346 				- largepic
5347 				- input_section->output_section->vma
5348 				- input_section->output_offset
5349 				- 12);
5350 		  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, relocation,
5351 			      contents + roff + 8 + largepic);
5352 		  /* Skip R_X86_64_PLT32/R_X86_64_PLTOFF64.  */
5353 		  rel++;
5354 		  wrel++;
5355 		  continue;
5356 		}
5357 	      else if (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info) == R_X86_64_GOTPC32_TLSDESC)
5358 		{
5359 		  /* GDesc -> IE transition.
5360 		     It's originally something like:
5361 		     leaq x@tlsdesc(%rip), %rax
5362 
5363 		     Change it to:
5364 		     movq x@gottpoff(%rip), %rax # before xchg %ax,%ax.  */
5365 
5366 		  /* Now modify the instruction as appropriate. To
5367 		     turn a leaq into a movq in the form we use it, it
5368 		     suffices to change the second byte from 0x8d to
5369 		     0x8b.  */
5370 		  bfd_put_8 (output_bfd, 0x8b, contents + roff - 2);
5371 
5372 		  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd,
5373 			      htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
5374 			      + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset + off
5375 			      - rel->r_offset
5376 			      - input_section->output_section->vma
5377 			      - input_section->output_offset
5378 			      - 4,
5379 			      contents + roff);
5380 		  continue;
5381 		}
5382 	      else if (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info) == R_X86_64_TLSDESC_CALL)
5383 		{
5384 		  /* GDesc -> IE transition.
5385 		     It's originally:
5386 		     call *(%rax)
5387 
5388 		     Change it to:
5389 		     xchg %ax, %ax.  */
5390 
5391 		  bfd_put_8 (output_bfd, 0x66, contents + roff);
5392 		  bfd_put_8 (output_bfd, 0x90, contents + roff + 1);
5393 		  continue;
5394 		}
5395 	      else
5396 		BFD_ASSERT (FALSE);
5397 	    }
5398 	  break;
5399 
5400 	case R_X86_64_TLSLD:
5401 	  if (! elf_x86_64_tls_transition (info, input_bfd,
5402 					   input_section, contents,
5403 					   symtab_hdr, sym_hashes,
5404 					   &r_type, GOT_UNKNOWN, rel,
5405 					   relend, h, r_symndx, TRUE))
5406 	    return FALSE;
5407 
5408 	  if (r_type != R_X86_64_TLSLD)
5409 	    {
5410 	      /* LD->LE transition:
5411 			leaq foo@tlsld(%rip), %rdi
5412 			call __tls_get_addr@PLT
5413 		 For 64bit, we change it into:
5414 			.word 0x6666; .byte 0x66; movq %fs:0, %rax
5415 		 For 32bit, we change it into:
5416 			nopl 0x0(%rax); movl %fs:0, %eax
5417 		 Or
5418 			leaq foo@tlsld(%rip), %rdi;
5419 			call *__tls_get_addr@GOTPCREL(%rip)
5420 			which may be converted to
5421 			addr32 call __tls_get_addr
5422 		 For 64bit, we change it into:
5423 			.word 0x6666; .word 0x6666; movq %fs:0, %rax
5424 		 For 32bit, we change it into:
5425 			nopw 0x0(%rax); movl %fs:0, %eax
5426 		 For largepic, change:
5427 			leaq foo@tlsgd(%rip), %rdi
5428 			movabsq $__tls_get_addr@pltoff, %rax
5429 			addq %rbx, %rax
5430 			call *%rax
5431 		 into
5432 			data16 data16 data16 nopw %cs:0x0(%rax,%rax,1)
5433 			movq %fs:0, %eax  */
5434 
5435 	      BFD_ASSERT (r_type == R_X86_64_TPOFF32);
5436 	      if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
5437 		{
5438 		  if (contents[rel->r_offset + 5] == 0xb8)
5439 		    memcpy (contents + rel->r_offset - 3,
5440 			    "\x66\x66\x66\x66\x2e\x0f\x1f\x84\0\0\0\0\0"
5441 			    "\x64\x48\x8b\x04\x25\0\0\0", 22);
5442 		  else if (contents[rel->r_offset + 4] == 0xff
5443 			   || contents[rel->r_offset + 4] == 0x67)
5444 		    memcpy (contents + rel->r_offset - 3,
5445 			    "\x66\x66\x66\x66\x64\x48\x8b\x04\x25\0\0\0",
5446 			    13);
5447 		  else
5448 		    memcpy (contents + rel->r_offset - 3,
5449 			    "\x66\x66\x66\x64\x48\x8b\x04\x25\0\0\0", 12);
5450 		}
5451 	      else
5452 		{
5453 		  if (contents[rel->r_offset + 4] == 0xff)
5454 		    memcpy (contents + rel->r_offset - 3,
5455 			    "\x66\x0f\x1f\x40\x00\x64\x8b\x04\x25\0\0\0",
5456 			    13);
5457 		  else
5458 		    memcpy (contents + rel->r_offset - 3,
5459 			    "\x0f\x1f\x40\x00\x64\x8b\x04\x25\0\0\0", 12);
5460 		}
5461 	      /* Skip R_X86_64_PC32, R_X86_64_PLT32, R_X86_64_GOTPCRELX
5462 		 and R_X86_64_PLTOFF64.  */
5463 	      rel++;
5464 	      wrel++;
5465 	      continue;
5466 	    }
5467 
5468 	  if (htab->elf.sgot == NULL)
5469 	    abort ();
5470 
5471 	  off = htab->tls_ld_got.offset;
5472 	  if (off & 1)
5473 	    off &= ~1;
5474 	  else
5475 	    {
5476 	      Elf_Internal_Rela outrel;
5477 
5478 	      if (htab->elf.srelgot == NULL)
5479 		abort ();
5480 
5481 	      outrel.r_offset = (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
5482 				 + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset + off);
5483 
5484 	      bfd_put_64 (output_bfd, 0,
5485 			  htab->elf.sgot->contents + off);
5486 	      bfd_put_64 (output_bfd, 0,
5487 			  htab->elf.sgot->contents + off + GOT_ENTRY_SIZE);
5488 	      outrel.r_info = htab->r_info (0, R_X86_64_DTPMOD64);
5489 	      outrel.r_addend = 0;
5490 	      elf_append_rela (output_bfd, htab->elf.srelgot,
5491 					&outrel);
5492 	      htab->tls_ld_got.offset |= 1;
5493 	    }
5494 	  relocation = htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
5495 		       + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset + off;
5496 	  unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
5497 	  break;
5498 
5499 	case R_X86_64_DTPOFF32:
5500 	  if (!bfd_link_executable (info)
5501 	      || (input_section->flags & SEC_CODE) == 0)
5502 	    relocation -= elf_x86_64_dtpoff_base (info);
5503 	  else
5504 	    relocation = elf_x86_64_tpoff (info, relocation);
5505 	  break;
5506 
5507 	case R_X86_64_TPOFF32:
5508 	case R_X86_64_TPOFF64:
5509 	  BFD_ASSERT (bfd_link_executable (info));
5510 	  relocation = elf_x86_64_tpoff (info, relocation);
5511 	  break;
5512 
5513 	case R_X86_64_DTPOFF64:
5514 	  BFD_ASSERT ((input_section->flags & SEC_CODE) == 0);
5515 	  relocation -= elf_x86_64_dtpoff_base (info);
5516 	  break;
5517 
5518 	default:
5519 	  break;
5520 	}
5521 
5522       /* Dynamic relocs are not propagated for SEC_DEBUGGING sections
5523 	 because such sections are not SEC_ALLOC and thus ld.so will
5524 	 not process them.  */
5525       if (unresolved_reloc
5526 	  && !((input_section->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING) != 0
5527 	       && h->def_dynamic)
5528 	  && _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section,
5529 				      rel->r_offset) != (bfd_vma) -1)
5530 	{
5531 	  (*_bfd_error_handler)
5532 	    (_("%B(%A+0x%lx): unresolvable %s relocation against symbol `%s'"),
5533 	     input_bfd,
5534 	     input_section,
5535 	     (long) rel->r_offset,
5536 	     howto->name,
5537 	     h->root.root.string);
5538 	  return FALSE;
5539 	}
5540 
5541 do_relocation:
5542       r = _bfd_final_link_relocate (howto, input_bfd, input_section,
5543 				    contents, rel->r_offset,
5544 				    relocation, rel->r_addend);
5545 
5546 check_relocation_error:
5547       if (r != bfd_reloc_ok)
5548 	{
5549 	  const char *name;
5550 
5551 	  if (h != NULL)
5552 	    name = h->root.root.string;
5553 	  else
5554 	    {
5555 	      name = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (input_bfd,
5556 						      symtab_hdr->sh_link,
5557 						      sym->st_name);
5558 	      if (name == NULL)
5559 		return FALSE;
5560 	      if (*name == '\0')
5561 		name = bfd_section_name (input_bfd, sec);
5562 	    }
5563 
5564 	  if (r == bfd_reloc_overflow)
5565 	    (*info->callbacks->reloc_overflow)
5566 	      (info, (h ? &h->root : NULL), name, howto->name,
5567 	       (bfd_vma) 0, input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset);
5568 	  else
5569 	    {
5570 	      (*_bfd_error_handler)
5571 		(_("%B(%A+0x%lx): reloc against `%s': error %d"),
5572 		 input_bfd, input_section,
5573 		 (long) rel->r_offset, name, (int) r);
5574 	      return FALSE;
5575 	    }
5576 	}
5577 
5578       if (wrel != rel)
5579 	*wrel = *rel;
5580     }
5581 
5582   if (wrel != rel)
5583     {
5584       Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
5585       size_t deleted = rel - wrel;
5586 
5587       rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (input_section->output_section);
5588       rel_hdr->sh_size -= rel_hdr->sh_entsize * deleted;
5589       if (rel_hdr->sh_size == 0)
5590 	{
5591 	  /* It is too late to remove an empty reloc section.  Leave
5592 	     one NONE reloc.
5593 	     ??? What is wrong with an empty section???  */
5594 	  rel_hdr->sh_size = rel_hdr->sh_entsize;
5595 	  deleted -= 1;
5596 	}
5597       rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (input_section);
5598       rel_hdr->sh_size -= rel_hdr->sh_entsize * deleted;
5599       input_section->reloc_count -= deleted;
5600     }
5601 
5602   return TRUE;
5603 }
5604 
5605 /* Finish up dynamic symbol handling.  We set the contents of various
5606    dynamic sections here.  */
5607 
5608 static bfd_boolean
5609 elf_x86_64_finish_dynamic_symbol (bfd *output_bfd,
5610 				  struct bfd_link_info *info,
5611 				  struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
5612 				  Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
5613 {
5614   struct elf_x86_64_link_hash_table *htab;
5615   const struct elf_x86_64_backend_data *abed;
5616   bfd_boolean use_plt_bnd;
5617   struct elf_x86_64_link_hash_entry *eh;
5618   bfd_boolean local_undefweak;
5619 
5620   htab = elf_x86_64_hash_table (info);
5621   if (htab == NULL)
5622     return FALSE;
5623 
5624   /* Use MPX backend data in case of BND relocation.  Use .plt_bnd
5625      section only if there is .plt section.  */
5626   use_plt_bnd = htab->elf.splt != NULL && htab->plt_bnd != NULL;
5627   abed = (use_plt_bnd
5628 	  ? &elf_x86_64_bnd_arch_bed
5629 	  : get_elf_x86_64_backend_data (output_bfd));
5630 
5631   eh = (struct elf_x86_64_link_hash_entry *) h;
5632 
5633   /* We keep PLT/GOT entries without dynamic PLT/GOT relocations for
5634      resolved undefined weak symbols in executable so that their
5635      references have value 0 at run-time.  */
5636   local_undefweak = UNDEFINED_WEAK_RESOLVED_TO_ZERO (info,
5637 						     eh->has_got_reloc,
5638 						     eh);
5639 
5640   if (h->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
5641     {
5642       bfd_vma plt_index;
5643       bfd_vma got_offset, plt_offset, plt_plt_offset, plt_got_offset;
5644       bfd_vma plt_plt_insn_end, plt_got_insn_size;
5645       Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
5646       bfd_byte *loc;
5647       asection *plt, *gotplt, *relplt, *resolved_plt;
5648       const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
5649       bfd_vma plt_got_pcrel_offset;
5650 
5651       /* When building a static executable, use .iplt, .igot.plt and
5652 	 .rela.iplt sections for STT_GNU_IFUNC symbols.  */
5653       if (htab->elf.splt != NULL)
5654 	{
5655 	  plt = htab->elf.splt;
5656 	  gotplt = htab->elf.sgotplt;
5657 	  relplt = htab->elf.srelplt;
5658 	}
5659       else
5660 	{
5661 	  plt = htab->elf.iplt;
5662 	  gotplt = htab->elf.igotplt;
5663 	  relplt = htab->elf.irelplt;
5664 	}
5665 
5666       /* This symbol has an entry in the procedure linkage table.  Set
5667 	 it up.	 */
5668       if ((h->dynindx == -1
5669 	   && !local_undefweak
5670 	   && !((h->forced_local || bfd_link_executable (info))
5671 		&& h->def_regular
5672 		&& h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC))
5673 	  || plt == NULL
5674 	  || gotplt == NULL
5675 	  || relplt == NULL)
5676 	abort ();
5677 
5678       /* Get the index in the procedure linkage table which
5679 	 corresponds to this symbol.  This is the index of this symbol
5680 	 in all the symbols for which we are making plt entries.  The
5681 	 first entry in the procedure linkage table is reserved.
5682 
5683 	 Get the offset into the .got table of the entry that
5684 	 corresponds to this function.	Each .got entry is GOT_ENTRY_SIZE
5685 	 bytes. The first three are reserved for the dynamic linker.
5686 
5687 	 For static executables, we don't reserve anything.  */
5688 
5689       if (plt == htab->elf.splt)
5690 	{
5691 	  got_offset = h->plt.offset / abed->plt_entry_size - 1;
5692 	  got_offset = (got_offset + 3) * GOT_ENTRY_SIZE;
5693 	}
5694       else
5695 	{
5696 	  got_offset = h->plt.offset / abed->plt_entry_size;
5697 	  got_offset = got_offset * GOT_ENTRY_SIZE;
5698 	}
5699 
5700       plt_plt_insn_end = abed->plt_plt_insn_end;
5701       plt_plt_offset = abed->plt_plt_offset;
5702       plt_got_insn_size = abed->plt_got_insn_size;
5703       plt_got_offset = abed->plt_got_offset;
5704       if (use_plt_bnd)
5705 	{
5706 	  /* Use the second PLT with BND relocations.  */
5707 	  const bfd_byte *plt_entry, *plt2_entry;
5708 
5709 	  if (eh->has_bnd_reloc)
5710 	    {
5711 	      plt_entry = elf_x86_64_bnd_plt_entry;
5712 	      plt2_entry = elf_x86_64_bnd_plt2_entry;
5713 	    }
5714 	  else
5715 	    {
5716 	      plt_entry = elf_x86_64_legacy_plt_entry;
5717 	      plt2_entry = elf_x86_64_legacy_plt2_entry;
5718 
5719 	      /* Subtract 1 since there is no BND prefix.  */
5720 	      plt_plt_insn_end -= 1;
5721 	      plt_plt_offset -= 1;
5722 	      plt_got_insn_size -= 1;
5723 	      plt_got_offset -= 1;
5724 	    }
5725 
5726 	  BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (elf_x86_64_bnd_plt_entry)
5727 		      == sizeof (elf_x86_64_legacy_plt_entry));
5728 
5729 	  /* Fill in the entry in the procedure linkage table.  */
5730 	  memcpy (plt->contents + h->plt.offset,
5731 		  plt_entry, sizeof (elf_x86_64_legacy_plt_entry));
5732 	  /* Fill in the entry in the second PLT.  */
5733 	  memcpy (htab->plt_bnd->contents + eh->plt_bnd.offset,
5734 		  plt2_entry, sizeof (elf_x86_64_legacy_plt2_entry));
5735 
5736 	  resolved_plt = htab->plt_bnd;
5737 	  plt_offset = eh->plt_bnd.offset;
5738 	}
5739       else
5740 	{
5741 	  /* Fill in the entry in the procedure linkage table.  */
5742 	  memcpy (plt->contents + h->plt.offset, abed->plt_entry,
5743 		  abed->plt_entry_size);
5744 
5745 	  resolved_plt = plt;
5746 	  plt_offset = h->plt.offset;
5747 	}
5748 
5749       /* Insert the relocation positions of the plt section.  */
5750 
5751       /* Put offset the PC-relative instruction referring to the GOT entry,
5752 	 subtracting the size of that instruction.  */
5753       plt_got_pcrel_offset = (gotplt->output_section->vma
5754 			      + gotplt->output_offset
5755 			      + got_offset
5756 			      - resolved_plt->output_section->vma
5757 			      - resolved_plt->output_offset
5758 			      - plt_offset
5759 			      - plt_got_insn_size);
5760 
5761       /* Check PC-relative offset overflow in PLT entry.  */
5762       if ((plt_got_pcrel_offset + 0x80000000) > 0xffffffff)
5763 	info->callbacks->einfo (_("%F%B: PC-relative offset overflow in PLT entry for `%s'\n"),
5764 				output_bfd, h->root.root.string);
5765 
5766       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_got_pcrel_offset,
5767 		  resolved_plt->contents + plt_offset + plt_got_offset);
5768 
5769       /* Fill in the entry in the global offset table, initially this
5770 	 points to the second part of the PLT entry.  Leave the entry
5771 	 as zero for undefined weak symbol in PIE.  No PLT relocation
5772 	 against undefined weak symbol in PIE.  */
5773       if (!local_undefweak)
5774 	{
5775 	  bfd_put_64 (output_bfd, (plt->output_section->vma
5776 				   + plt->output_offset
5777 				   + h->plt.offset
5778 				   + abed->plt_lazy_offset),
5779 		      gotplt->contents + got_offset);
5780 
5781 	  /* Fill in the entry in the .rela.plt section.  */
5782 	  rela.r_offset = (gotplt->output_section->vma
5783 			   + gotplt->output_offset
5784 			   + got_offset);
5785 	  if (h->dynindx == -1
5786 	      || ((bfd_link_executable (info)
5787 		   || ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) != STV_DEFAULT)
5788 		  && h->def_regular
5789 		  && h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC))
5790 	    {
5791 	      /* If an STT_GNU_IFUNC symbol is locally defined, generate
5792 		 R_X86_64_IRELATIVE instead of R_X86_64_JUMP_SLOT.  */
5793 	      rela.r_info = htab->r_info (0, R_X86_64_IRELATIVE);
5794 	      rela.r_addend = (h->root.u.def.value
5795 			       + h->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma
5796 			       + h->root.u.def.section->output_offset);
5797 	      /* R_X86_64_IRELATIVE comes last.  */
5798 	      plt_index = htab->next_irelative_index--;
5799 	    }
5800 	  else
5801 	    {
5802 	      rela.r_info = htab->r_info (h->dynindx, R_X86_64_JUMP_SLOT);
5803 	      rela.r_addend = 0;
5804 	      plt_index = htab->next_jump_slot_index++;
5805 	    }
5806 
5807 	  /* Don't fill PLT entry for static executables.  */
5808 	  if (plt == htab->elf.splt)
5809 	    {
5810 	      bfd_vma plt0_offset = h->plt.offset + plt_plt_insn_end;
5811 
5812 	      /* Put relocation index.  */
5813 	      bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_index,
5814 			  (plt->contents + h->plt.offset
5815 			   + abed->plt_reloc_offset));
5816 
5817 	      /* Put offset for jmp .PLT0 and check for overflow.  We don't
5818 		 check relocation index for overflow since branch displacement
5819 		 will overflow first.  */
5820 	      if (plt0_offset > 0x80000000)
5821 		info->callbacks->einfo (_("%F%B: branch displacement overflow in PLT entry for `%s'\n"),
5822 					output_bfd, h->root.root.string);
5823 	      bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, - plt0_offset,
5824 			  plt->contents + h->plt.offset + plt_plt_offset);
5825 	    }
5826 
5827 	  bed = get_elf_backend_data (output_bfd);
5828 	  loc = relplt->contents + plt_index * bed->s->sizeof_rela;
5829 	  bed->s->swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
5830 	}
5831     }
5832   else if (eh->plt_got.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
5833     {
5834       bfd_vma got_offset, plt_offset, plt_got_offset, plt_got_insn_size;
5835       asection *plt, *got;
5836       bfd_boolean got_after_plt;
5837       int32_t got_pcrel_offset;
5838       const bfd_byte *got_plt_entry;
5839 
5840       /* Set the entry in the GOT procedure linkage table.  */
5841       plt = htab->plt_got;
5842       got = htab->elf.sgot;
5843       got_offset = h->got.offset;
5844 
5845       if (got_offset == (bfd_vma) -1
5846 	  || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
5847 	  || plt == NULL
5848 	  || got == NULL)
5849 	abort ();
5850 
5851       /* Use the second PLT entry template for the GOT PLT since they
5852 	 are the identical.  */
5853       plt_got_insn_size = elf_x86_64_bnd_arch_bed.plt_got_insn_size;
5854       plt_got_offset = elf_x86_64_bnd_arch_bed.plt_got_offset;
5855       if (eh->has_bnd_reloc)
5856 	got_plt_entry = elf_x86_64_bnd_plt2_entry;
5857       else
5858 	{
5859 	  got_plt_entry = elf_x86_64_legacy_plt2_entry;
5860 
5861 	  /* Subtract 1 since there is no BND prefix.  */
5862 	  plt_got_insn_size -= 1;
5863 	  plt_got_offset -= 1;
5864 	}
5865 
5866       /* Fill in the entry in the GOT procedure linkage table.  */
5867       plt_offset = eh->plt_got.offset;
5868       memcpy (plt->contents + plt_offset,
5869 	      got_plt_entry, sizeof (elf_x86_64_legacy_plt2_entry));
5870 
5871       /* Put offset the PC-relative instruction referring to the GOT
5872 	 entry, subtracting the size of that instruction.  */
5873       got_pcrel_offset = (got->output_section->vma
5874 			  + got->output_offset
5875 			  + got_offset
5876 			  - plt->output_section->vma
5877 			  - plt->output_offset
5878 			  - plt_offset
5879 			  - plt_got_insn_size);
5880 
5881       /* Check PC-relative offset overflow in GOT PLT entry.  */
5882       got_after_plt = got->output_section->vma > plt->output_section->vma;
5883       if ((got_after_plt && got_pcrel_offset < 0)
5884 	  || (!got_after_plt && got_pcrel_offset > 0))
5885 	info->callbacks->einfo (_("%F%B: PC-relative offset overflow in GOT PLT entry for `%s'\n"),
5886 				output_bfd, h->root.root.string);
5887 
5888       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, got_pcrel_offset,
5889 		  plt->contents + plt_offset + plt_got_offset);
5890     }
5891 
5892   if (!local_undefweak
5893       && !h->def_regular
5894       && (h->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1
5895 	  || eh->plt_got.offset != (bfd_vma) -1))
5896     {
5897       /* Mark the symbol as undefined, rather than as defined in
5898 	 the .plt section.  Leave the value if there were any
5899 	 relocations where pointer equality matters (this is a clue
5900 	 for the dynamic linker, to make function pointer
5901 	 comparisons work between an application and shared
5902 	 library), otherwise set it to zero.  If a function is only
5903 	 called from a binary, there is no need to slow down
5904 	 shared libraries because of that.  */
5905       sym->st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
5906       if (!h->pointer_equality_needed)
5907 	sym->st_value = 0;
5908     }
5909 
5910   /* Don't generate dynamic GOT relocation against undefined weak
5911      symbol in executable.  */
5912   if (h->got.offset != (bfd_vma) -1
5913       && ! GOT_TLS_GD_ANY_P (elf_x86_64_hash_entry (h)->tls_type)
5914       && elf_x86_64_hash_entry (h)->tls_type != GOT_TLS_IE
5915       && !local_undefweak)
5916     {
5917       Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
5918       asection *relgot = htab->elf.srelgot;
5919 
5920       /* This symbol has an entry in the global offset table.  Set it
5921 	 up.  */
5922       if (htab->elf.sgot == NULL || htab->elf.srelgot == NULL)
5923 	abort ();
5924 
5925       rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
5926 		       + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset
5927 		       + (h->got.offset &~ (bfd_vma) 1));
5928 
5929       /* If this is a static link, or it is a -Bsymbolic link and the
5930 	 symbol is defined locally or was forced to be local because
5931 	 of a version file, we just want to emit a RELATIVE reloc.
5932 	 The entry in the global offset table will already have been
5933 	 initialized in the relocate_section function.  */
5934       if (h->def_regular
5935 	  && h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5936 	{
5937 	  if (h->plt.offset == (bfd_vma) -1)
5938 	    {
5939 	      /* STT_GNU_IFUNC is referenced without PLT.  */
5940 	      if (htab->elf.splt == NULL)
5941 		{
5942 		  /* use .rel[a].iplt section to store .got relocations
5943 		     in static executable.  */
5944 		  relgot = htab->elf.irelplt;
5945 		}
5946 	      if (SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
5947 		{
5948 		  rela.r_info = htab->r_info (0,
5949 					      R_X86_64_IRELATIVE);
5950 		  rela.r_addend = (h->root.u.def.value
5951 				   + h->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma
5952 				   + h->root.u.def.section->output_offset);
5953 		}
5954 	      else
5955 		goto do_glob_dat;
5956 	    }
5957 	  else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5958 	    {
5959 	      /* Generate R_X86_64_GLOB_DAT.  */
5960 	      goto do_glob_dat;
5961 	    }
5962 	  else
5963 	    {
5964 	      asection *plt;
5965 
5966 	      if (!h->pointer_equality_needed)
5967 		abort ();
5968 
5969 	      /* For non-shared object, we can't use .got.plt, which
5970 		 contains the real function addres if we need pointer
5971 		 equality.  We load the GOT entry with the PLT entry.  */
5972 	      plt = htab->elf.splt ? htab->elf.splt : htab->elf.iplt;
5973 	      bfd_put_64 (output_bfd, (plt->output_section->vma
5974 				       + plt->output_offset
5975 				       + h->plt.offset),
5976 			  htab->elf.sgot->contents + h->got.offset);
5977 	      return TRUE;
5978 	    }
5979 	}
5980       else if (bfd_link_pic (info)
5981 	       && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
5982 	{
5983 	  if (!h->def_regular)
5984 	    return FALSE;
5985 	  BFD_ASSERT((h->got.offset & 1) != 0);
5986 	  rela.r_info = htab->r_info (0, R_X86_64_RELATIVE);
5987 	  rela.r_addend = (h->root.u.def.value
5988 			   + h->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma
5989 			   + h->root.u.def.section->output_offset);
5990 	}
5991       else
5992 	{
5993 	  BFD_ASSERT((h->got.offset & 1) == 0);
5994 do_glob_dat:
5995 	  bfd_put_64 (output_bfd, (bfd_vma) 0,
5996 		      htab->elf.sgot->contents + h->got.offset);
5997 	  rela.r_info = htab->r_info (h->dynindx, R_X86_64_GLOB_DAT);
5998 	  rela.r_addend = 0;
5999 	}
6000 
6001       elf_append_rela (output_bfd, relgot, &rela);
6002     }
6003 
6004   if (h->needs_copy)
6005     {
6006       Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
6007 
6008       /* This symbol needs a copy reloc.  Set it up.  */
6009 
6010       if (h->dynindx == -1
6011 	  || (h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_defined
6012 	      && h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_defweak)
6013 	  || htab->srelbss == NULL)
6014 	abort ();
6015 
6016       rela.r_offset = (h->root.u.def.value
6017 		       + h->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma
6018 		       + h->root.u.def.section->output_offset);
6019       rela.r_info = htab->r_info (h->dynindx, R_X86_64_COPY);
6020       rela.r_addend = 0;
6021       elf_append_rela (output_bfd, htab->srelbss, &rela);
6022     }
6023 
6024   return TRUE;
6025 }
6026 
6027 /* Finish up local dynamic symbol handling.  We set the contents of
6028    various dynamic sections here.  */
6029 
6030 static bfd_boolean
6031 elf_x86_64_finish_local_dynamic_symbol (void **slot, void *inf)
6032 {
6033   struct elf_link_hash_entry *h
6034     = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) *slot;
6035   struct bfd_link_info *info
6036     = (struct bfd_link_info *) inf;
6037 
6038   return elf_x86_64_finish_dynamic_symbol (info->output_bfd,
6039 					     info, h, NULL);
6040 }
6041 
6042 /* Finish up undefined weak symbol handling in PIE.  Fill its PLT entry
6043    here since undefined weak symbol may not be dynamic and may not be
6044    called for elf_x86_64_finish_dynamic_symbol.  */
6045 
6046 static bfd_boolean
6047 elf_x86_64_pie_finish_undefweak_symbol (struct bfd_hash_entry *bh,
6048 					void *inf)
6049 {
6050   struct elf_link_hash_entry *h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
6051   struct bfd_link_info *info = (struct bfd_link_info *) inf;
6052 
6053   if (h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak
6054       || h->dynindx != -1)
6055     return TRUE;
6056 
6057   return elf_x86_64_finish_dynamic_symbol (info->output_bfd,
6058 					     info, h, NULL);
6059 }
6060 
6061 /* Used to decide how to sort relocs in an optimal manner for the
6062    dynamic linker, before writing them out.  */
6063 
6064 static enum elf_reloc_type_class
6065 elf_x86_64_reloc_type_class (const struct bfd_link_info *info,
6066 			     const asection *rel_sec ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
6067 			     const Elf_Internal_Rela *rela)
6068 {
6069   bfd *abfd = info->output_bfd;
6070   const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6071   struct elf_x86_64_link_hash_table *htab = elf_x86_64_hash_table (info);
6072 
6073   if (htab->elf.dynsym != NULL
6074       && htab->elf.dynsym->contents != NULL)
6075     {
6076       /* Check relocation against STT_GNU_IFUNC symbol if there are
6077          dynamic symbols.  */
6078       unsigned long r_symndx = htab->r_sym (rela->r_info);
6079       if (r_symndx != STN_UNDEF)
6080 	{
6081 	  Elf_Internal_Sym sym;
6082 	  if (!bed->s->swap_symbol_in (abfd,
6083 				       (htab->elf.dynsym->contents
6084 					+ r_symndx * bed->s->sizeof_sym),
6085 				       0, &sym))
6086 	    abort ();
6087 
6088 	  if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym.st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
6089 	    return reloc_class_ifunc;
6090 	}
6091     }
6092 
6093   switch ((int) ELF32_R_TYPE (rela->r_info))
6094     {
6095     case R_X86_64_IRELATIVE:
6096       return reloc_class_ifunc;
6097     case R_X86_64_RELATIVE:
6098     case R_X86_64_RELATIVE64:
6099       return reloc_class_relative;
6100     case R_X86_64_JUMP_SLOT:
6101       return reloc_class_plt;
6102     case R_X86_64_COPY:
6103       return reloc_class_copy;
6104     default:
6105       return reloc_class_normal;
6106     }
6107 }
6108 
6109 /* Finish up the dynamic sections.  */
6110 
6111 static bfd_boolean
6112 elf_x86_64_finish_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
6113 				    struct bfd_link_info *info)
6114 {
6115   struct elf_x86_64_link_hash_table *htab;
6116   bfd *dynobj;
6117   asection *sdyn;
6118   const struct elf_x86_64_backend_data *abed;
6119 
6120   htab = elf_x86_64_hash_table (info);
6121   if (htab == NULL)
6122     return FALSE;
6123 
6124   /* Use MPX backend data in case of BND relocation.  Use .plt_bnd
6125      section only if there is .plt section.  */
6126   abed = (htab->elf.splt != NULL && htab->plt_bnd != NULL
6127 	  ? &elf_x86_64_bnd_arch_bed
6128 	  : get_elf_x86_64_backend_data (output_bfd));
6129 
6130   dynobj = htab->elf.dynobj;
6131   sdyn = bfd_get_linker_section (dynobj, ".dynamic");
6132 
6133   if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
6134     {
6135       bfd_byte *dyncon, *dynconend;
6136       const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
6137       bfd_size_type sizeof_dyn;
6138 
6139       if (sdyn == NULL || htab->elf.sgot == NULL)
6140 	abort ();
6141 
6142       bed = get_elf_backend_data (dynobj);
6143       sizeof_dyn = bed->s->sizeof_dyn;
6144       dyncon = sdyn->contents;
6145       dynconend = sdyn->contents + sdyn->size;
6146       for (; dyncon < dynconend; dyncon += sizeof_dyn)
6147 	{
6148 	  Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
6149 	  asection *s;
6150 
6151 	  (*bed->s->swap_dyn_in) (dynobj, dyncon, &dyn);
6152 
6153 	  switch (dyn.d_tag)
6154 	    {
6155 	    default:
6156 	      continue;
6157 
6158 	    case DT_PLTGOT:
6159 	      s = htab->elf.sgotplt;
6160 	      dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
6161 	      break;
6162 
6163 	    case DT_JMPREL:
6164 	      dyn.d_un.d_ptr = htab->elf.srelplt->output_section->vma;
6165 	      break;
6166 
6167 	    case DT_PLTRELSZ:
6168 	      s = htab->elf.srelplt->output_section;
6169 	      dyn.d_un.d_val = s->size;
6170 	      break;
6171 
6172 	    case DT_RELASZ:
6173 	      /* The procedure linkage table relocs (DT_JMPREL) should
6174 		 not be included in the overall relocs (DT_RELA).
6175 		 Therefore, we override the DT_RELASZ entry here to
6176 		 make it not include the JMPREL relocs.  Since the
6177 		 linker script arranges for .rela.plt to follow all
6178 		 other relocation sections, we don't have to worry
6179 		 about changing the DT_RELA entry.  */
6180 	      if (htab->elf.srelplt != NULL)
6181 		{
6182 		  s = htab->elf.srelplt->output_section;
6183 		  dyn.d_un.d_val -= s->size;
6184 		}
6185 	      break;
6186 
6187 	    case DT_TLSDESC_PLT:
6188 	      s = htab->elf.splt;
6189 	      dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset
6190 		+ htab->tlsdesc_plt;
6191 	      break;
6192 
6193 	    case DT_TLSDESC_GOT:
6194 	      s = htab->elf.sgot;
6195 	      dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset
6196 		+ htab->tlsdesc_got;
6197 	      break;
6198 	    }
6199 
6200 	  (*bed->s->swap_dyn_out) (output_bfd, &dyn, dyncon);
6201 	}
6202 
6203       /* Fill in the special first entry in the procedure linkage table.  */
6204       if (htab->elf.splt && htab->elf.splt->size > 0)
6205 	{
6206 	  /* Fill in the first entry in the procedure linkage table.  */
6207 	  memcpy (htab->elf.splt->contents,
6208 		  abed->plt0_entry, abed->plt_entry_size);
6209 	  /* Add offset for pushq GOT+8(%rip), since the instruction
6210 	     uses 6 bytes subtract this value.  */
6211 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd,
6212 		      (htab->elf.sgotplt->output_section->vma
6213 		       + htab->elf.sgotplt->output_offset
6214 		       + 8
6215 		       - htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
6216 		       - htab->elf.splt->output_offset
6217 		       - 6),
6218 		      htab->elf.splt->contents + abed->plt0_got1_offset);
6219 	  /* Add offset for the PC-relative instruction accessing GOT+16,
6220 	     subtracting the offset to the end of that instruction.  */
6221 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd,
6222 		      (htab->elf.sgotplt->output_section->vma
6223 		       + htab->elf.sgotplt->output_offset
6224 		       + 16
6225 		       - htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
6226 		       - htab->elf.splt->output_offset
6227 		       - abed->plt0_got2_insn_end),
6228 		      htab->elf.splt->contents + abed->plt0_got2_offset);
6229 
6230 	  elf_section_data (htab->elf.splt->output_section)
6231 	    ->this_hdr.sh_entsize = abed->plt_entry_size;
6232 
6233 	  if (htab->tlsdesc_plt)
6234 	    {
6235 	      bfd_put_64 (output_bfd, (bfd_vma) 0,
6236 			  htab->elf.sgot->contents + htab->tlsdesc_got);
6237 
6238 	      memcpy (htab->elf.splt->contents + htab->tlsdesc_plt,
6239 		      abed->plt0_entry, abed->plt_entry_size);
6240 
6241 	      /* Add offset for pushq GOT+8(%rip), since the
6242 		 instruction uses 6 bytes subtract this value.  */
6243 	      bfd_put_32 (output_bfd,
6244 			  (htab->elf.sgotplt->output_section->vma
6245 			   + htab->elf.sgotplt->output_offset
6246 			   + 8
6247 			   - htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
6248 			   - htab->elf.splt->output_offset
6249 			   - htab->tlsdesc_plt
6250 			   - 6),
6251 			  htab->elf.splt->contents
6252 			  + htab->tlsdesc_plt + abed->plt0_got1_offset);
6253 	  /* Add offset for the PC-relative instruction accessing GOT+TDG,
6254 	     where TGD stands for htab->tlsdesc_got, subtracting the offset
6255 	     to the end of that instruction.  */
6256 	      bfd_put_32 (output_bfd,
6257 			  (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
6258 			   + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset
6259 			   + htab->tlsdesc_got
6260 			   - htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
6261 			   - htab->elf.splt->output_offset
6262 			   - htab->tlsdesc_plt
6263 			   - abed->plt0_got2_insn_end),
6264 			  htab->elf.splt->contents
6265 			  + htab->tlsdesc_plt + abed->plt0_got2_offset);
6266 	    }
6267 	}
6268     }
6269 
6270   if (htab->plt_bnd != NULL)
6271     elf_section_data (htab->plt_bnd->output_section)
6272       ->this_hdr.sh_entsize = sizeof (elf_x86_64_bnd_plt2_entry);
6273 
6274   if (htab->elf.sgotplt)
6275     {
6276       if (bfd_is_abs_section (htab->elf.sgotplt->output_section))
6277 	{
6278 	  (*_bfd_error_handler)
6279 	    (_("discarded output section: `%A'"), htab->elf.sgotplt);
6280 	  return FALSE;
6281 	}
6282 
6283       /* Fill in the first three entries in the global offset table.  */
6284       if (htab->elf.sgotplt->size > 0)
6285 	{
6286 	  /* Set the first entry in the global offset table to the address of
6287 	     the dynamic section.  */
6288 	  if (sdyn == NULL)
6289 	    bfd_put_64 (output_bfd, (bfd_vma) 0, htab->elf.sgotplt->contents);
6290 	  else
6291 	    bfd_put_64 (output_bfd,
6292 			sdyn->output_section->vma + sdyn->output_offset,
6293 			htab->elf.sgotplt->contents);
6294 	  /* Write GOT[1] and GOT[2], needed for the dynamic linker.  */
6295 	  bfd_put_64 (output_bfd, (bfd_vma) 0, htab->elf.sgotplt->contents + GOT_ENTRY_SIZE);
6296 	  bfd_put_64 (output_bfd, (bfd_vma) 0, htab->elf.sgotplt->contents + GOT_ENTRY_SIZE*2);
6297 	}
6298 
6299       elf_section_data (htab->elf.sgotplt->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_entsize =
6300 	GOT_ENTRY_SIZE;
6301     }
6302 
6303   /* Adjust .eh_frame for .plt section.  */
6304   if (htab->plt_eh_frame != NULL
6305       && htab->plt_eh_frame->contents != NULL)
6306     {
6307       if (htab->elf.splt != NULL
6308 	  && htab->elf.splt->size != 0
6309 	  && (htab->elf.splt->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) == 0
6310 	  && htab->elf.splt->output_section != NULL
6311 	  && htab->plt_eh_frame->output_section != NULL)
6312 	{
6313 	  bfd_vma plt_start = htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma;
6314 	  bfd_vma eh_frame_start = htab->plt_eh_frame->output_section->vma
6315 				   + htab->plt_eh_frame->output_offset
6316 				   + PLT_FDE_START_OFFSET;
6317 	  bfd_put_signed_32 (dynobj, plt_start - eh_frame_start,
6318 			     htab->plt_eh_frame->contents
6319 			     + PLT_FDE_START_OFFSET);
6320 	}
6321       if (htab->plt_eh_frame->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_EH_FRAME)
6322 	{
6323 	  if (! _bfd_elf_write_section_eh_frame (output_bfd, info,
6324 						 htab->plt_eh_frame,
6325 						 htab->plt_eh_frame->contents))
6326 	    return FALSE;
6327 	}
6328     }
6329 
6330   if (htab->elf.sgot && htab->elf.sgot->size > 0)
6331     elf_section_data (htab->elf.sgot->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_entsize
6332       = GOT_ENTRY_SIZE;
6333 
6334   /* Fill PLT entries for undefined weak symbols in PIE.  */
6335   if (bfd_link_pie (info))
6336     bfd_hash_traverse (&info->hash->table,
6337 		       elf_x86_64_pie_finish_undefweak_symbol,
6338 		       info);
6339 
6340   return TRUE;
6341 }
6342 
6343 /* Fill PLT/GOT entries and allocate dynamic relocations for local
6344    STT_GNU_IFUNC symbols, which aren't in the ELF linker hash table.
6345    It has to be done before elf_link_sort_relocs is called so that
6346    dynamic relocations are properly sorted.  */
6347 
6348 static bfd_boolean
6349 elf_x86_64_output_arch_local_syms
6350   (bfd *output_bfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
6351    struct bfd_link_info *info,
6352    void *flaginfo ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
6353    int (*func) (void *, const char *,
6354 		Elf_Internal_Sym *,
6355 		asection *,
6356 		struct elf_link_hash_entry *) ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
6357 {
6358   struct elf_x86_64_link_hash_table *htab = elf_x86_64_hash_table (info);
6359   if (htab == NULL)
6360     return FALSE;
6361 
6362   /* Fill PLT and GOT entries for local STT_GNU_IFUNC symbols.  */
6363   htab_traverse (htab->loc_hash_table,
6364 		 elf_x86_64_finish_local_dynamic_symbol,
6365 		 info);
6366 
6367   return TRUE;
6368 }
6369 
6370 /* Return an array of PLT entry symbol values.  */
6371 
6372 static bfd_vma *
6373 elf_x86_64_get_plt_sym_val (bfd *abfd, asymbol **dynsyms, asection *plt,
6374 			    asection *relplt)
6375 {
6376   bfd_boolean (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bfd_boolean);
6377   arelent *p;
6378   long count, i;
6379   bfd_vma *plt_sym_val;
6380   bfd_vma plt_offset;
6381   bfd_byte *plt_contents;
6382   const struct elf_x86_64_backend_data *bed;
6383   Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
6384   asection *plt_bnd;
6385 
6386   /* Get the .plt section contents.  PLT passed down may point to the
6387      .plt.bnd section.  Make sure that PLT always points to the .plt
6388      section.  */
6389   plt_bnd = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".plt.bnd");
6390   if (plt_bnd)
6391     {
6392       if (plt != plt_bnd)
6393 	abort ();
6394       plt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".plt");
6395       if (plt == NULL)
6396 	abort ();
6397       bed = &elf_x86_64_bnd_arch_bed;
6398     }
6399   else
6400     bed = get_elf_x86_64_backend_data (abfd);
6401 
6402   plt_contents = (bfd_byte *) bfd_malloc (plt->size);
6403   if (plt_contents == NULL)
6404     return NULL;
6405   if (!bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, (asection *) plt,
6406 				 plt_contents, 0, plt->size))
6407     {
6408 bad_return:
6409       free (plt_contents);
6410       return NULL;
6411     }
6412 
6413   slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
6414   if (! (*slurp_relocs) (abfd, relplt, dynsyms, TRUE))
6415     goto bad_return;
6416 
6417   hdr = &elf_section_data (relplt)->this_hdr;
6418   count = relplt->size / hdr->sh_entsize;
6419 
6420   plt_sym_val = (bfd_vma *) bfd_malloc (sizeof (bfd_vma) * count);
6421   if (plt_sym_val == NULL)
6422     goto bad_return;
6423 
6424   for (i = 0; i < count; i++)
6425     plt_sym_val[i] = -1;
6426 
6427   plt_offset = bed->plt_entry_size;
6428   p = relplt->relocation;
6429   for (i = 0; i < count; i++, p++)
6430     {
6431       long reloc_index;
6432 
6433       /* Skip unknown relocation.  */
6434       if (p->howto == NULL)
6435 	continue;
6436 
6437       if (p->howto->type != R_X86_64_JUMP_SLOT
6438 	  && p->howto->type != R_X86_64_IRELATIVE)
6439 	continue;
6440 
6441       reloc_index = H_GET_32 (abfd, (plt_contents + plt_offset
6442 				     + bed->plt_reloc_offset));
6443       if (reloc_index < count)
6444 	{
6445 	  if (plt_bnd)
6446 	    {
6447 	      /* This is the index in .plt section.  */
6448 	      long plt_index = plt_offset / bed->plt_entry_size;
6449 	      /* Store VMA + the offset in .plt.bnd section.  */
6450 	      plt_sym_val[reloc_index] =
6451 		(plt_bnd->vma
6452 		 + (plt_index - 1) * sizeof (elf_x86_64_legacy_plt2_entry));
6453 	    }
6454 	  else
6455 	    plt_sym_val[reloc_index] = plt->vma + plt_offset;
6456 	}
6457       plt_offset += bed->plt_entry_size;
6458 
6459       /* PR binutils/18437: Skip extra relocations in the .rela.plt
6460 	 section.  */
6461       if (plt_offset >= plt->size)
6462 	break;
6463     }
6464 
6465   free (plt_contents);
6466 
6467   return plt_sym_val;
6468 }
6469 
6470 /* Similar to _bfd_elf_get_synthetic_symtab, with .plt.bnd section
6471    support.  */
6472 
6473 static long
6474 elf_x86_64_get_synthetic_symtab (bfd *abfd,
6475 				 long symcount,
6476 				 asymbol **syms,
6477 				 long dynsymcount,
6478 				 asymbol **dynsyms,
6479 				 asymbol **ret)
6480 {
6481   /* Pass the .plt.bnd section to _bfd_elf_ifunc_get_synthetic_symtab
6482      as PLT if it exists.  */
6483   asection *plt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".plt.bnd");
6484   if (plt == NULL)
6485     plt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".plt");
6486   return _bfd_elf_ifunc_get_synthetic_symtab (abfd, symcount, syms,
6487 					      dynsymcount, dynsyms, ret,
6488 					      plt,
6489 					      elf_x86_64_get_plt_sym_val);
6490 }
6491 
6492 /* Handle an x86-64 specific section when reading an object file.  This
6493    is called when elfcode.h finds a section with an unknown type.  */
6494 
6495 static bfd_boolean
6496 elf_x86_64_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr,
6497 			      const char *name, int shindex)
6498 {
6499   if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_X86_64_UNWIND)
6500     return FALSE;
6501 
6502   if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
6503     return FALSE;
6504 
6505   return TRUE;
6506 }
6507 
6508 /* Hook called by the linker routine which adds symbols from an object
6509    file.  We use it to put SHN_X86_64_LCOMMON items in .lbss, instead
6510    of .bss.  */
6511 
6512 static bfd_boolean
6513 elf_x86_64_add_symbol_hook (bfd *abfd,
6514 			    struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
6515 			    Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
6516 			    const char **namep ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
6517 			    flagword *flagsp ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
6518 			    asection **secp,
6519 			    bfd_vma *valp)
6520 {
6521   asection *lcomm;
6522 
6523   switch (sym->st_shndx)
6524     {
6525     case SHN_X86_64_LCOMMON:
6526       lcomm = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, "LARGE_COMMON");
6527       if (lcomm == NULL)
6528 	{
6529 	  lcomm = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd,
6530 					       "LARGE_COMMON",
6531 					       (SEC_ALLOC
6532 						| SEC_IS_COMMON
6533 						| SEC_LINKER_CREATED));
6534 	  if (lcomm == NULL)
6535 	    return FALSE;
6536 	  elf_section_flags (lcomm) |= SHF_X86_64_LARGE;
6537 	}
6538       *secp = lcomm;
6539       *valp = sym->st_size;
6540       return TRUE;
6541     }
6542 
6543   return TRUE;
6544 }
6545 
6546 
6547 /* Given a BFD section, try to locate the corresponding ELF section
6548    index.  */
6549 
6550 static bfd_boolean
6551 elf_x86_64_elf_section_from_bfd_section (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
6552 					 asection *sec, int *index_return)
6553 {
6554   if (sec == &_bfd_elf_large_com_section)
6555     {
6556       *index_return = SHN_X86_64_LCOMMON;
6557       return TRUE;
6558     }
6559   return FALSE;
6560 }
6561 
6562 /* Process a symbol.  */
6563 
6564 static void
6565 elf_x86_64_symbol_processing (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
6566 			      asymbol *asym)
6567 {
6568   elf_symbol_type *elfsym = (elf_symbol_type *) asym;
6569 
6570   switch (elfsym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx)
6571     {
6572     case SHN_X86_64_LCOMMON:
6573       asym->section = &_bfd_elf_large_com_section;
6574       asym->value = elfsym->internal_elf_sym.st_size;
6575       /* Common symbol doesn't set BSF_GLOBAL.  */
6576       asym->flags &= ~BSF_GLOBAL;
6577       break;
6578     }
6579 }
6580 
6581 static bfd_boolean
6582 elf_x86_64_common_definition (Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
6583 {
6584   return (sym->st_shndx == SHN_COMMON
6585 	  || sym->st_shndx == SHN_X86_64_LCOMMON);
6586 }
6587 
6588 static unsigned int
6589 elf_x86_64_common_section_index (asection *sec)
6590 {
6591   if ((elf_section_flags (sec) & SHF_X86_64_LARGE) == 0)
6592     return SHN_COMMON;
6593   else
6594     return SHN_X86_64_LCOMMON;
6595 }
6596 
6597 static asection *
6598 elf_x86_64_common_section (asection *sec)
6599 {
6600   if ((elf_section_flags (sec) & SHF_X86_64_LARGE) == 0)
6601     return bfd_com_section_ptr;
6602   else
6603     return &_bfd_elf_large_com_section;
6604 }
6605 
6606 static bfd_boolean
6607 elf_x86_64_merge_symbol (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
6608 			 const Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
6609 			 asection **psec,
6610 			 bfd_boolean newdef,
6611 			 bfd_boolean olddef,
6612 			 bfd *oldbfd,
6613 			 const asection *oldsec)
6614 {
6615   /* A normal common symbol and a large common symbol result in a
6616      normal common symbol.  We turn the large common symbol into a
6617      normal one.  */
6618   if (!olddef
6619       && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_common
6620       && !newdef
6621       && bfd_is_com_section (*psec)
6622       && oldsec != *psec)
6623     {
6624       if (sym->st_shndx == SHN_COMMON
6625 	  && (elf_section_flags (oldsec) & SHF_X86_64_LARGE) != 0)
6626 	{
6627 	  h->root.u.c.p->section
6628 	    = bfd_make_section_old_way (oldbfd, "COMMON");
6629 	  h->root.u.c.p->section->flags = SEC_ALLOC;
6630 	}
6631       else if (sym->st_shndx == SHN_X86_64_LCOMMON
6632 	       && (elf_section_flags (oldsec) & SHF_X86_64_LARGE) == 0)
6633 	*psec = bfd_com_section_ptr;
6634     }
6635 
6636   return TRUE;
6637 }
6638 
6639 static int
6640 elf_x86_64_additional_program_headers (bfd *abfd,
6641 				       struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
6642 {
6643   asection *s;
6644   int count = 0;
6645 
6646   /* Check to see if we need a large readonly segment.  */
6647   s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".lrodata");
6648   if (s && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD))
6649     count++;
6650 
6651   /* Check to see if we need a large data segment.  Since .lbss sections
6652      is placed right after the .bss section, there should be no need for
6653      a large data segment just because of .lbss.  */
6654   s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".ldata");
6655   if (s && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD))
6656     count++;
6657 
6658   return count;
6659 }
6660 
6661 /* Return TRUE if symbol should be hashed in the `.gnu.hash' section.  */
6662 
6663 static bfd_boolean
6664 elf_x86_64_hash_symbol (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
6665 {
6666   if (h->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1
6667       && !h->def_regular
6668       && !h->pointer_equality_needed)
6669     return FALSE;
6670 
6671   return _bfd_elf_hash_symbol (h);
6672 }
6673 
6674 /* Return TRUE iff relocations for INPUT are compatible with OUTPUT. */
6675 
6676 static bfd_boolean
6677 elf_x86_64_relocs_compatible (const bfd_target *input,
6678 			      const bfd_target *output)
6679 {
6680   return ((xvec_get_elf_backend_data (input)->s->elfclass
6681 	   == xvec_get_elf_backend_data (output)->s->elfclass)
6682 	  && _bfd_elf_relocs_compatible (input, output));
6683 }
6684 
6685 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section
6686   elf_x86_64_special_sections[]=
6687 {
6688   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.linkonce.lb"), -2, SHT_NOBITS,   SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_X86_64_LARGE},
6689   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.linkonce.lr"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_X86_64_LARGE},
6690   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.linkonce.lt"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR + SHF_X86_64_LARGE},
6691   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".lbss"),	           -2, SHT_NOBITS,   SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_X86_64_LARGE},
6692   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".ldata"),	   -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_X86_64_LARGE},
6693   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".lrodata"),	   -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_X86_64_LARGE},
6694   { NULL,	                0,          0, 0,            0 }
6695 };
6696 
6697 #define TARGET_LITTLE_SYM		    x86_64_elf64_vec
6698 #define TARGET_LITTLE_NAME		    "elf64-x86-64"
6699 #define ELF_ARCH			    bfd_arch_i386
6700 #define ELF_TARGET_ID			    X86_64_ELF_DATA
6701 #define ELF_MACHINE_CODE		    EM_X86_64
6702 #define ELF_MAXPAGESIZE			    0x200000
6703 #define ELF_MINPAGESIZE			    0x1000
6704 #define ELF_COMMONPAGESIZE		    0x1000
6705 
6706 #define elf_backend_can_gc_sections	    1
6707 #define elf_backend_can_refcount	    1
6708 #define elf_backend_want_got_plt	    1
6709 #define elf_backend_plt_readonly	    1
6710 #define elf_backend_want_plt_sym	    0
6711 #define elf_backend_got_header_size	    (GOT_ENTRY_SIZE*3)
6712 #define elf_backend_rela_normal		    1
6713 #define elf_backend_plt_alignment           4
6714 #define elf_backend_extern_protected_data   1
6715 #define elf_backend_caches_rawsize	    1
6716 
6717 #define elf_info_to_howto		    elf_x86_64_info_to_howto
6718 
6719 #define bfd_elf64_bfd_link_hash_table_create \
6720   elf_x86_64_link_hash_table_create
6721 #define bfd_elf64_bfd_reloc_type_lookup	    elf_x86_64_reloc_type_lookup
6722 #define bfd_elf64_bfd_reloc_name_lookup \
6723   elf_x86_64_reloc_name_lookup
6724 
6725 #define elf_backend_adjust_dynamic_symbol   elf_x86_64_adjust_dynamic_symbol
6726 #define elf_backend_relocs_compatible	    elf_x86_64_relocs_compatible
6727 #define elf_backend_check_relocs	    elf_x86_64_check_relocs
6728 #define elf_backend_copy_indirect_symbol    elf_x86_64_copy_indirect_symbol
6729 #define elf_backend_create_dynamic_sections elf_x86_64_create_dynamic_sections
6730 #define elf_backend_finish_dynamic_sections elf_x86_64_finish_dynamic_sections
6731 #define elf_backend_finish_dynamic_symbol   elf_x86_64_finish_dynamic_symbol
6732 #define elf_backend_output_arch_local_syms  elf_x86_64_output_arch_local_syms
6733 #define elf_backend_gc_mark_hook	    elf_x86_64_gc_mark_hook
6734 #define elf_backend_grok_prstatus	    elf_x86_64_grok_prstatus
6735 #define elf_backend_grok_psinfo		    elf_x86_64_grok_psinfo
6736 #ifdef CORE_HEADER
6737 #define elf_backend_write_core_note	    elf_x86_64_write_core_note
6738 #endif
6739 #define elf_backend_reloc_type_class	    elf_x86_64_reloc_type_class
6740 #define elf_backend_relocate_section	    elf_x86_64_relocate_section
6741 #define elf_backend_size_dynamic_sections   elf_x86_64_size_dynamic_sections
6742 #define elf_backend_always_size_sections    elf_x86_64_always_size_sections
6743 #define elf_backend_init_index_section	    _bfd_elf_init_1_index_section
6744 #define elf_backend_object_p		    elf64_x86_64_elf_object_p
6745 #define bfd_elf64_mkobject		    elf_x86_64_mkobject
6746 #define bfd_elf64_get_synthetic_symtab	    elf_x86_64_get_synthetic_symtab
6747 
6748 #define elf_backend_section_from_shdr \
6749 	elf_x86_64_section_from_shdr
6750 
6751 #define elf_backend_section_from_bfd_section \
6752   elf_x86_64_elf_section_from_bfd_section
6753 #define elf_backend_add_symbol_hook \
6754   elf_x86_64_add_symbol_hook
6755 #define elf_backend_symbol_processing \
6756   elf_x86_64_symbol_processing
6757 #define elf_backend_common_section_index \
6758   elf_x86_64_common_section_index
6759 #define elf_backend_common_section \
6760   elf_x86_64_common_section
6761 #define elf_backend_common_definition \
6762   elf_x86_64_common_definition
6763 #define elf_backend_merge_symbol \
6764   elf_x86_64_merge_symbol
6765 #define elf_backend_special_sections \
6766   elf_x86_64_special_sections
6767 #define elf_backend_additional_program_headers \
6768   elf_x86_64_additional_program_headers
6769 #define elf_backend_hash_symbol \
6770   elf_x86_64_hash_symbol
6771 #define elf_backend_omit_section_dynsym \
6772   ((bfd_boolean (*) (bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *, asection *)) bfd_true)
6773 #define elf_backend_fixup_symbol \
6774   elf_x86_64_fixup_symbol
6775 
6776 #include "elf64-target.h"
6777 
6778 /* CloudABI support.  */
6779 
6780 #undef  TARGET_LITTLE_SYM
6781 #define TARGET_LITTLE_SYM		    x86_64_elf64_cloudabi_vec
6782 #undef  TARGET_LITTLE_NAME
6783 #define TARGET_LITTLE_NAME		    "elf64-x86-64-cloudabi"
6784 
6785 #undef	ELF_OSABI
6786 #define	ELF_OSABI			    ELFOSABI_CLOUDABI
6787 
6788 #undef  elf64_bed
6789 #define elf64_bed elf64_x86_64_cloudabi_bed
6790 
6791 #include "elf64-target.h"
6792 
6793 /* FreeBSD support.  */
6794 
6795 #undef  TARGET_LITTLE_SYM
6796 #define TARGET_LITTLE_SYM		    x86_64_elf64_fbsd_vec
6797 #undef  TARGET_LITTLE_NAME
6798 #define TARGET_LITTLE_NAME		    "elf64-x86-64-freebsd"
6799 
6800 #undef	ELF_OSABI
6801 #define	ELF_OSABI			    ELFOSABI_FREEBSD
6802 
6803 #undef  elf64_bed
6804 #define elf64_bed elf64_x86_64_fbsd_bed
6805 
6806 #include "elf64-target.h"
6807 
6808 /* Solaris 2 support.  */
6809 
6810 #undef  TARGET_LITTLE_SYM
6811 #define TARGET_LITTLE_SYM		    x86_64_elf64_sol2_vec
6812 #undef  TARGET_LITTLE_NAME
6813 #define TARGET_LITTLE_NAME		    "elf64-x86-64-sol2"
6814 
6815 /* Restore default: we cannot use ELFOSABI_SOLARIS, otherwise ELFOSABI_NONE
6816    objects won't be recognized.  */
6817 #undef ELF_OSABI
6818 
6819 #undef  elf64_bed
6820 #define elf64_bed			    elf64_x86_64_sol2_bed
6821 
6822 /* The 64-bit static TLS arena size is rounded to the nearest 16-byte
6823    boundary.  */
6824 #undef  elf_backend_static_tls_alignment
6825 #define elf_backend_static_tls_alignment    16
6826 
6827 /* The Solaris 2 ABI requires a plt symbol on all platforms.
6828 
6829    Cf. Linker and Libraries Guide, Ch. 2, Link-Editor, Generating the Output
6830    File, p.63.  */
6831 #undef  elf_backend_want_plt_sym
6832 #define elf_backend_want_plt_sym	    1
6833 
6834 #undef  elf_backend_strtab_flags
6835 #define elf_backend_strtab_flags	SHF_STRINGS
6836 
6837 static bfd_boolean
6838 elf64_x86_64_copy_solaris_special_section_fields (const bfd *ibfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
6839 						  bfd *obfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
6840 						  const Elf_Internal_Shdr *isection ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
6841 						  Elf_Internal_Shdr *osection ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
6842 {
6843   /* PR 19938: FIXME: Need to add code for setting the sh_info
6844      and sh_link fields of Solaris specific section types.  */
6845   return FALSE;
6846 }
6847 
6848 #undef  elf_backend_copy_special_section_fields
6849 #define elf_backend_copy_special_section_fields elf64_x86_64_copy_solaris_special_section_fields
6850 
6851 #include "elf64-target.h"
6852 
6853 /* Native Client support.  */
6854 
6855 static bfd_boolean
6856 elf64_x86_64_nacl_elf_object_p (bfd *abfd)
6857 {
6858   /* Set the right machine number for a NaCl x86-64 ELF64 file.  */
6859   bfd_default_set_arch_mach (abfd, bfd_arch_i386, bfd_mach_x86_64_nacl);
6860   return TRUE;
6861 }
6862 
6863 #undef	TARGET_LITTLE_SYM
6864 #define	TARGET_LITTLE_SYM		x86_64_elf64_nacl_vec
6865 #undef	TARGET_LITTLE_NAME
6866 #define	TARGET_LITTLE_NAME		"elf64-x86-64-nacl"
6867 #undef	elf64_bed
6868 #define	elf64_bed			elf64_x86_64_nacl_bed
6869 
6870 #undef	ELF_MAXPAGESIZE
6871 #undef	ELF_MINPAGESIZE
6872 #undef	ELF_COMMONPAGESIZE
6873 #define ELF_MAXPAGESIZE			0x10000
6874 #define ELF_MINPAGESIZE			0x10000
6875 #define ELF_COMMONPAGESIZE		0x10000
6876 
6877 /* Restore defaults.  */
6878 #undef	ELF_OSABI
6879 #undef	elf_backend_static_tls_alignment
6880 #undef	elf_backend_want_plt_sym
6881 #define elf_backend_want_plt_sym	0
6882 #undef  elf_backend_strtab_flags
6883 #undef  elf_backend_copy_special_section_fields
6884 
6885 /* NaCl uses substantially different PLT entries for the same effects.  */
6886 
6887 #undef	elf_backend_plt_alignment
6888 #define elf_backend_plt_alignment	5
6889 #define NACL_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE		64
6890 #define	NACLMASK			0xe0 /* 32-byte alignment mask.  */
6891 
6892 static const bfd_byte elf_x86_64_nacl_plt0_entry[NACL_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE] =
6893   {
6894     0xff, 0x35, 8, 0, 0, 0,             /* pushq GOT+8(%rip) 		*/
6895     0x4c, 0x8b, 0x1d, 16, 0, 0, 0,	/* mov GOT+16(%rip), %r11	*/
6896     0x41, 0x83, 0xe3, NACLMASK,         /* and $-32, %r11d		*/
6897     0x4d, 0x01, 0xfb,             	/* add %r15, %r11		*/
6898     0x41, 0xff, 0xe3,             	/* jmpq *%r11			*/
6899 
6900     /* 9-byte nop sequence to pad out to the next 32-byte boundary.  */
6901     0x66, 0x0f, 0x1f, 0x84, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, /* nopw 0x0(%rax,%rax,1)	*/
6902 
6903     /* 32 bytes of nop to pad out to the standard size.  */
6904     0x66, 0x66, 0x66, 0x66, 0x66, 0x66,    /* excess data16 prefixes	*/
6905     0x2e, 0x0f, 0x1f, 0x84, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, /* nopw %cs:0x0(%rax,%rax,1)	*/
6906     0x66, 0x66, 0x66, 0x66, 0x66, 0x66,    /* excess data16 prefixes	*/
6907     0x2e, 0x0f, 0x1f, 0x84, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, /* nopw %cs:0x0(%rax,%rax,1)	*/
6908     0x66,                                  /* excess data16 prefix	*/
6909     0x90                                   /* nop */
6910   };
6911 
6912 static const bfd_byte elf_x86_64_nacl_plt_entry[NACL_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE] =
6913   {
6914     0x4c, 0x8b, 0x1d, 0, 0, 0, 0,	/* mov name@GOTPCREL(%rip),%r11	*/
6915     0x41, 0x83, 0xe3, NACLMASK,         /* and $-32, %r11d		*/
6916     0x4d, 0x01, 0xfb,             	/* add %r15, %r11		*/
6917     0x41, 0xff, 0xe3,             	/* jmpq *%r11			*/
6918 
6919     /* 15-byte nop sequence to pad out to the next 32-byte boundary.  */
6920     0x66, 0x66, 0x66, 0x66, 0x66, 0x66,    /* excess data16 prefixes	*/
6921     0x2e, 0x0f, 0x1f, 0x84, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, /* nopw %cs:0x0(%rax,%rax,1)	*/
6922 
6923     /* Lazy GOT entries point here (32-byte aligned).  */
6924     0x68,                 /* pushq immediate */
6925     0, 0, 0, 0,           /* replaced with index into relocation table.  */
6926     0xe9,                 /* jmp relative */
6927     0, 0, 0, 0,           /* replaced with offset to start of .plt0.  */
6928 
6929     /* 22 bytes of nop to pad out to the standard size.  */
6930     0x66, 0x66, 0x66, 0x66, 0x66, 0x66,    /* excess data16 prefixes	*/
6931     0x2e, 0x0f, 0x1f, 0x84, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, /* nopw %cs:0x0(%rax,%rax,1)	*/
6932     0x0f, 0x1f, 0x80, 0, 0, 0, 0,          /* nopl 0x0(%rax)		*/
6933   };
6934 
6935 /* .eh_frame covering the .plt section.  */
6936 
6937 static const bfd_byte elf_x86_64_nacl_eh_frame_plt[] =
6938   {
6939 #if (PLT_CIE_LENGTH != 20                               \
6940      || PLT_FDE_LENGTH != 36                            \
6941      || PLT_FDE_START_OFFSET != 4 + PLT_CIE_LENGTH + 8  \
6942      || PLT_FDE_LEN_OFFSET != 4 + PLT_CIE_LENGTH + 12)
6943 # error "Need elf_x86_64_backend_data parameters for eh_frame_plt offsets!"
6944 #endif
6945     PLT_CIE_LENGTH, 0, 0, 0,	/* CIE length */
6946     0, 0, 0, 0,			/* CIE ID */
6947     1,				/* CIE version */
6948     'z', 'R', 0,                /* Augmentation string */
6949     1,				/* Code alignment factor */
6950     0x78,                       /* Data alignment factor */
6951     16,				/* Return address column */
6952     1,				/* Augmentation size */
6953     DW_EH_PE_pcrel | DW_EH_PE_sdata4, /* FDE encoding */
6954     DW_CFA_def_cfa, 7, 8,	/* DW_CFA_def_cfa: r7 (rsp) ofs 8 */
6955     DW_CFA_offset + 16, 1,	/* DW_CFA_offset: r16 (rip) at cfa-8 */
6956     DW_CFA_nop, DW_CFA_nop,
6957 
6958     PLT_FDE_LENGTH, 0, 0, 0,	/* FDE length */
6959     PLT_CIE_LENGTH + 8, 0, 0, 0,/* CIE pointer */
6960     0, 0, 0, 0,			/* R_X86_64_PC32 .plt goes here */
6961     0, 0, 0, 0,			/* .plt size goes here */
6962     0,				/* Augmentation size */
6963     DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset, 16,	/* DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset: 16 */
6964     DW_CFA_advance_loc + 6,	/* DW_CFA_advance_loc: 6 to __PLT__+6 */
6965     DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset, 24,	/* DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset: 24 */
6966     DW_CFA_advance_loc + 58,	/* DW_CFA_advance_loc: 58 to __PLT__+64 */
6967     DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression,	/* DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression */
6968     13,				/* Block length */
6969     DW_OP_breg7, 8,		/* DW_OP_breg7 (rsp): 8 */
6970     DW_OP_breg16, 0,		/* DW_OP_breg16 (rip): 0 */
6971     DW_OP_const1u, 63, DW_OP_and, DW_OP_const1u, 37, DW_OP_ge,
6972     DW_OP_lit3, DW_OP_shl, DW_OP_plus,
6973     DW_CFA_nop, DW_CFA_nop
6974   };
6975 
6976 static const struct elf_x86_64_backend_data elf_x86_64_nacl_arch_bed =
6977   {
6978     elf_x86_64_nacl_plt0_entry,              /* plt0_entry */
6979     elf_x86_64_nacl_plt_entry,               /* plt_entry */
6980     NACL_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE,                     /* plt_entry_size */
6981     2,                                       /* plt0_got1_offset */
6982     9,                                       /* plt0_got2_offset */
6983     13,                                      /* plt0_got2_insn_end */
6984     3,                                       /* plt_got_offset */
6985     33,                                      /* plt_reloc_offset */
6986     38,                                      /* plt_plt_offset */
6987     7,                                       /* plt_got_insn_size */
6988     42,                                      /* plt_plt_insn_end */
6989     32,                                      /* plt_lazy_offset */
6990     elf_x86_64_nacl_eh_frame_plt,            /* eh_frame_plt */
6991     sizeof (elf_x86_64_nacl_eh_frame_plt),   /* eh_frame_plt_size */
6992   };
6993 
6994 #undef	elf_backend_arch_data
6995 #define	elf_backend_arch_data	&elf_x86_64_nacl_arch_bed
6996 
6997 #undef	elf_backend_object_p
6998 #define elf_backend_object_p			elf64_x86_64_nacl_elf_object_p
6999 #undef	elf_backend_modify_segment_map
7000 #define	elf_backend_modify_segment_map		nacl_modify_segment_map
7001 #undef	elf_backend_modify_program_headers
7002 #define	elf_backend_modify_program_headers	nacl_modify_program_headers
7003 #undef	elf_backend_final_write_processing
7004 #define elf_backend_final_write_processing	nacl_final_write_processing
7005 
7006 #include "elf64-target.h"
7007 
7008 /* Native Client x32 support.  */
7009 
7010 static bfd_boolean
7011 elf32_x86_64_nacl_elf_object_p (bfd *abfd)
7012 {
7013   /* Set the right machine number for a NaCl x86-64 ELF32 file.  */
7014   bfd_default_set_arch_mach (abfd, bfd_arch_i386, bfd_mach_x64_32_nacl);
7015   return TRUE;
7016 }
7017 
7018 #undef  TARGET_LITTLE_SYM
7019 #define TARGET_LITTLE_SYM		x86_64_elf32_nacl_vec
7020 #undef  TARGET_LITTLE_NAME
7021 #define TARGET_LITTLE_NAME		"elf32-x86-64-nacl"
7022 #undef	elf32_bed
7023 #define	elf32_bed			elf32_x86_64_nacl_bed
7024 
7025 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create \
7026   elf_x86_64_link_hash_table_create
7027 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_reloc_type_lookup	\
7028   elf_x86_64_reloc_type_lookup
7029 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_reloc_name_lookup \
7030   elf_x86_64_reloc_name_lookup
7031 #define bfd_elf32_mkobject \
7032   elf_x86_64_mkobject
7033 #define bfd_elf32_get_synthetic_symtab \
7034   elf_x86_64_get_synthetic_symtab
7035 
7036 #undef elf_backend_object_p
7037 #define elf_backend_object_p \
7038   elf32_x86_64_nacl_elf_object_p
7039 
7040 #undef elf_backend_bfd_from_remote_memory
7041 #define elf_backend_bfd_from_remote_memory \
7042   _bfd_elf32_bfd_from_remote_memory
7043 
7044 #undef elf_backend_size_info
7045 #define elf_backend_size_info \
7046   _bfd_elf32_size_info
7047 
7048 #include "elf32-target.h"
7049 
7050 /* Restore defaults.  */
7051 #undef	elf_backend_object_p
7052 #define elf_backend_object_p		    elf64_x86_64_elf_object_p
7053 #undef	elf_backend_bfd_from_remote_memory
7054 #undef	elf_backend_size_info
7055 #undef	elf_backend_modify_segment_map
7056 #undef	elf_backend_modify_program_headers
7057 #undef	elf_backend_final_write_processing
7058 
7059 /* Intel L1OM support.  */
7060 
7061 static bfd_boolean
7062 elf64_l1om_elf_object_p (bfd *abfd)
7063 {
7064   /* Set the right machine number for an L1OM elf64 file.  */
7065   bfd_default_set_arch_mach (abfd, bfd_arch_l1om, bfd_mach_l1om);
7066   return TRUE;
7067 }
7068 
7069 #undef  TARGET_LITTLE_SYM
7070 #define TARGET_LITTLE_SYM		    l1om_elf64_vec
7071 #undef  TARGET_LITTLE_NAME
7072 #define TARGET_LITTLE_NAME		    "elf64-l1om"
7073 #undef ELF_ARCH
7074 #define ELF_ARCH			    bfd_arch_l1om
7075 
7076 #undef	ELF_MACHINE_CODE
7077 #define ELF_MACHINE_CODE		    EM_L1OM
7078 
7079 #undef	ELF_OSABI
7080 
7081 #undef  elf64_bed
7082 #define elf64_bed elf64_l1om_bed
7083 
7084 #undef elf_backend_object_p
7085 #define elf_backend_object_p		    elf64_l1om_elf_object_p
7086 
7087 /* Restore defaults.  */
7088 #undef	ELF_MAXPAGESIZE
7089 #undef	ELF_MINPAGESIZE
7090 #undef	ELF_COMMONPAGESIZE
7091 #define ELF_MAXPAGESIZE			0x200000
7092 #define ELF_MINPAGESIZE			0x1000
7093 #define ELF_COMMONPAGESIZE		0x1000
7094 #undef	elf_backend_plt_alignment
7095 #define elf_backend_plt_alignment	4
7096 #undef	elf_backend_arch_data
7097 #define	elf_backend_arch_data	&elf_x86_64_arch_bed
7098 
7099 #include "elf64-target.h"
7100 
7101 /* FreeBSD L1OM support.  */
7102 
7103 #undef  TARGET_LITTLE_SYM
7104 #define TARGET_LITTLE_SYM		    l1om_elf64_fbsd_vec
7105 #undef  TARGET_LITTLE_NAME
7106 #define TARGET_LITTLE_NAME		    "elf64-l1om-freebsd"
7107 
7108 #undef	ELF_OSABI
7109 #define	ELF_OSABI			    ELFOSABI_FREEBSD
7110 
7111 #undef  elf64_bed
7112 #define elf64_bed elf64_l1om_fbsd_bed
7113 
7114 #include "elf64-target.h"
7115 
7116 /* Intel K1OM support.  */
7117 
7118 static bfd_boolean
7119 elf64_k1om_elf_object_p (bfd *abfd)
7120 {
7121   /* Set the right machine number for an K1OM elf64 file.  */
7122   bfd_default_set_arch_mach (abfd, bfd_arch_k1om, bfd_mach_k1om);
7123   return TRUE;
7124 }
7125 
7126 #undef  TARGET_LITTLE_SYM
7127 #define TARGET_LITTLE_SYM		    k1om_elf64_vec
7128 #undef  TARGET_LITTLE_NAME
7129 #define TARGET_LITTLE_NAME		    "elf64-k1om"
7130 #undef ELF_ARCH
7131 #define ELF_ARCH			    bfd_arch_k1om
7132 
7133 #undef	ELF_MACHINE_CODE
7134 #define ELF_MACHINE_CODE		    EM_K1OM
7135 
7136 #undef	ELF_OSABI
7137 
7138 #undef  elf64_bed
7139 #define elf64_bed elf64_k1om_bed
7140 
7141 #undef elf_backend_object_p
7142 #define elf_backend_object_p		    elf64_k1om_elf_object_p
7143 
7144 #undef  elf_backend_static_tls_alignment
7145 
7146 #undef elf_backend_want_plt_sym
7147 #define elf_backend_want_plt_sym	    0
7148 
7149 #include "elf64-target.h"
7150 
7151 /* FreeBSD K1OM support.  */
7152 
7153 #undef  TARGET_LITTLE_SYM
7154 #define TARGET_LITTLE_SYM		    k1om_elf64_fbsd_vec
7155 #undef  TARGET_LITTLE_NAME
7156 #define TARGET_LITTLE_NAME		    "elf64-k1om-freebsd"
7157 
7158 #undef	ELF_OSABI
7159 #define	ELF_OSABI			    ELFOSABI_FREEBSD
7160 
7161 #undef  elf64_bed
7162 #define elf64_bed elf64_k1om_fbsd_bed
7163 
7164 #include "elf64-target.h"
7165 
7166 /* 32bit x86-64 support.  */
7167 
7168 #undef  TARGET_LITTLE_SYM
7169 #define TARGET_LITTLE_SYM		    x86_64_elf32_vec
7170 #undef  TARGET_LITTLE_NAME
7171 #define TARGET_LITTLE_NAME		    "elf32-x86-64"
7172 #undef	elf32_bed
7173 
7174 #undef ELF_ARCH
7175 #define ELF_ARCH			    bfd_arch_i386
7176 
7177 #undef	ELF_MACHINE_CODE
7178 #define ELF_MACHINE_CODE		    EM_X86_64
7179 
7180 #undef	ELF_OSABI
7181 
7182 #undef elf_backend_object_p
7183 #define elf_backend_object_p \
7184   elf32_x86_64_elf_object_p
7185 
7186 #undef elf_backend_bfd_from_remote_memory
7187 #define elf_backend_bfd_from_remote_memory \
7188   _bfd_elf32_bfd_from_remote_memory
7189 
7190 #undef elf_backend_size_info
7191 #define elf_backend_size_info \
7192   _bfd_elf32_size_info
7193 
7194 #include "elf32-target.h"
7195